321 Studios Two Way Radio F 520 User Manual

Plain-paper digital Fax/Copier/Printer/Scanner  
User Guide  
www.muratec.com  
Muratec America, Inc.  
3301 E, Plano Parkway, Suite 100  
Plano, Texas 75074  
0
31981 92618  
8
MAI order number: OMF520  
MML item number: DA7-90390-62  
Muratec America, Inc. 2005  
Printed in China  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
As an Energy Star® partner, Muratec has determined that this prod-  
uct meets the Energy Star® guidelines for energy efficiency.  
Super G3 is an extension of Group 3 fax technology standards, allow-  
ing the use of high-speed ITU-T V.34 modems for 33.6 Kbps transmis-  
sion and high-speed protocols for rapid handshaking.  
JBIG — Joint Bi-level Image experts Group, the new ITU-T standard  
image data compression method. As JBIG compresses the data more  
efficiently than MMR, it is especially effective when transmitting half-  
tone (grayscale) image document.  
QuadAccess  
QuadAccess is a more powerful version of what already is a pretty  
powerful feature, called dual access. While a fax with normal dual  
access allows you to do two things at once, QuadAccess allows you to  
do four operations at once. For example, even if the machine is (1)  
printing a copy, (2) transmitting from memory and (3) scanning docu-  
ments for a different memory transmission, you can still (4) program  
the machine.  
Trademarks  
Muratec, the Muratec logo and all Muratec product names contained herein are trademarks of  
Murata machinery, Ltd and Muratec America, Inc.  
QuadAccess is registered trademark of Muratec America Inc.  
All other products referenced are registered trademarks or trademarks of their respective com-  
panies.  
This manual and any updates to it can be found online at www.muratec.com  
Go to the “Products” section of this site, then click on “MFX-2030” or “MFX-1430” or “F-560” or  
“F-520”.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Welcome  
Thank you for choosing the Muratec MFX-2030/MFX-  
1430/F-560/F-520.  
This User Manual describes the functions, operating  
procedures, precautions, and basic troubleshooting for  
the  
Getting Started  
Using the Address Book  
Faxing  
1
Muratec MFX-2030/MFX-1430/F-560/F-520.  
Before using this machine, be sure to read the User  
Manual thoroughly in order to ensure that you use the  
machine efficiently. After you have gone through the  
manual, keep it handy at all times.  
2
3
Note that some of the illustrations of the machine used  
in the User Manual may be different from what you  
actually see on your machine.  
Internet Fax functions  
Scanning  
4
5
The Manual  
Reviewing or canceling commands  
Copying  
6
There are five manuals for this machine. The description  
for each manual is as follows:  
7
Quick Reference Guide  
Explains most frequently used functions and how to  
clean paper jams.  
PC Fax functions  
8
User Guide  
PC Printing  
Explains all the functions of your machine and the infor-  
mation of maintenance.  
9
Network Guide  
Special features  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Explains about network settings.  
Local Printer and Scanner Manual [CD]  
Explains how to install the drivers and the information  
of print driver properties etc.  
Restricting use of the machine  
Machine Settings  
Network Printer Manual [CD]  
Explains how to install the driver and how to use the  
PC-Fax function.  
Report & Lists  
[CD]: Located on the driver CD  
Maintenance & Troubleshooting  
Appendix & Index  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Regulatory information........................................................................................................ I-1  
United States of America ................................................................................................ I-1  
Canada ............................................................................................................................. I-2  
Limited warranty ................................................................................................................. I-3  
Precautions........................................................................................................................... I-5  
Installation precautions .................................................................................................. I-5  
Power requirements ........................................................................................................ I-6  
Space requirements......................................................................................................... I-7  
General precautions ........................................................................................................ I-7  
Storing and handling the toner and drum cartridges ................................................... I-8  
Legal restrictions on copying .......................................................................................... I-9  
Caution labels..................................................................................................................... I-10  
Symbols and terms............................................................................................................. I-11  
Main Features .................................................................................................................... I-12  
Copy ............................................................................................................................... I-12  
Copy/Fax......................................................................................................................... I-12  
Copy/Fax/Scan................................................................................................................ I-13  
Fax.................................................................................................................................. I-14  
Mail ................................................................................................................................ I-15  
Fax/Mail ......................................................................................................................... I-15  
Scan................................................................................................................................ I-16  
General........................................................................................................................... I-17  
Chapter 1  
Getting Started ...........................................................................................................................1-1  
Machine overview.................................................................................................................1-2  
Machine layout ................................................................................................................1-2  
Control panel overview....................................................................................................1-3  
Operating tips.......................................................................................................................1-4  
Changing modes ..............................................................................................................1-4  
Operating the display......................................................................................................1-4  
Display description..........................................................................................................1-4  
Key displays and functions .............................................................................................1-9  
Entering characters.......................................................................................................1-10  
Memory back-up ............................................................................................................1-13  
Initial setup ........................................................................................................................1-14  
Clearing stored settings ................................................................................................1-14  
Getting started...............................................................................................................1-15  
Specifying the initial settings .......................................................................................1-16  
Using the Energy save mode.........................................................................................1-23  
Document and paper handling ..........................................................................................1-24  
Document handling .......................................................................................................1-24  
Paper handling...............................................................................................................1-26  
Chapter 2  
Using the Address Book............................................................................................................2-1  
The address book..................................................................................................................2-2  
The address book display ................................................................................................2-2  
Special dialing characters ...............................................................................................2-3  
Registering destinations in Address Book ..........................................................................2-4  
Registering or editing a destination...............................................................................2-4  
Alternative 1: Registering or editing directly into the address book............................2-7  
Alternative 2: Registering or editing the fax number using the numeric keys............2-8  
Alternative 3: Registering an e-mail address using the QWERTY keypad..................2-9  
Deleting a destination ...................................................................................................2-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alternative: Deleting directly from the address book..................................................2-11  
How to dial using the address book..............................................................................2-12  
Call group dialing...............................................................................................................2-14  
Registering or editing a call group ...............................................................................2-14  
Deleting a call group .....................................................................................................2-15  
How to dial using a call group ......................................................................................2-16  
Making a phone call ...........................................................................................................2-19  
How to dial using the address book..............................................................................2-19  
If the call fails................................................................................................................2-20  
How to receive a phone call...........................................................................................2-20  
Adjusting the optional handset volume........................................................................2-20  
Adjusting the speaker volume ......................................................................................2-21  
Chapter 3  
Faxing............................................................................................................................................3-1  
Before sending......................................................................................................................3-2  
Document handling .........................................................................................................3-2  
Scanning resolution.........................................................................................................3-2  
Scanning contrast............................................................................................................3-3  
Sending method...............................................................................................................3-3  
Memory overflow message ..............................................................................................3-4  
Sending a fax ........................................................................................................................3-5  
Memory transmission......................................................................................................3-5  
Real-time transmission (non-memory transmission) ....................................................3-8  
Manual transmission (non-memory transmission)........................................................3-9  
Changing Document Scan in Mid Scan (Mixed Transmission)...................................3-10  
Redialing.............................................................................................................................3-13  
Automatic fax redialing.................................................................................................3-13  
Manual redialing ...........................................................................................................3-13  
Receiving a fax....................................................................................................................3-15  
Selecting the reception mode ........................................................................................3-15  
Manual reception mode.................................................................................................3-15  
Automatic reception mode.............................................................................................3-16  
Answering calls manually.............................................................................................3-17  
If paper runs out during fax reception .........................................................................3-17  
Settings for fax reception...................................................................................................3-20  
Setting the number of rings..........................................................................................3-20  
Print settings .................................................................................................................3-20  
Advanced fax functions ......................................................................................................3-23  
Broadcasting ..................................................................................................................3-24  
Fax & Copy.....................................................................................................................3-28  
Sending faxes with TTI information attached .............................................................3-30  
Cover page......................................................................................................................3-32  
Delayed transmission....................................................................................................3-34  
Batch transmission........................................................................................................3-35  
Specifying the document scanning size........................................................................3-41  
Polling transmission......................................................................................................3-42  
Overseas transmission ..................................................................................................3-43  
Using an alternative telephone network service provider (Dial prefix) .....................3-44  
Block junk fax ................................................................................................................3-46  
Polling reception ............................................................................................................3-50  
Fax forwarding...............................................................................................................3-51  
Separator page...............................................................................................................3-57  
Chapter 4  
Internet Fax functions ..............................................................................................................4-1  
Before sending......................................................................................................................4-2  
Sending an e-mail.................................................................................................................4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering an e-mail address using the QWERTY keypad..............................................4-2  
Re-mail.............................................................................................................................4-3  
Mail History.....................................................................................................................4-4  
Reviewing or canceling commands......................................................................................4-6  
Advanced mail functions......................................................................................................4-6  
Adding a text message to your e-mail ............................................................................4-7  
Batch scanning ..............................................................................................................4-11  
Checking for new e-mail................................................................................................4-12  
Specifying the attachment file format..........................................................................4-13  
Chapter 5  
Scanning.......................................................................................................................................5-1  
Before scanning ....................................................................................................................5-2  
Resolution ........................................................................................................................5-2  
Contrast ...........................................................................................................................5-3  
Document type.................................................................................................................5-4  
Scan size...........................................................................................................................5-5  
Entering the file name.....................................................................................................5-6  
Scan to e-mail .......................................................................................................................5-9  
Sending a document by e-mail........................................................................................5-9  
Selecting a destination from the Address Book ...........................................................5-11  
Searching for an e-mail address ...................................................................................5-15  
Sending a document using the mail history.................................................................5-21  
Re-mail...........................................................................................................................5-22  
Reviewing or changing your selected destinations......................................................5-23  
Adding a text message to your e-mail ..........................................................................5-24  
Scan to folder......................................................................................................................5-28  
Scanning documents into a folder.................................................................................5-28  
Scanning documents using a folder shortcut ...............................................................5-33  
Reviewing or canceling selected folders .......................................................................5-34  
Registering or editing a folder shortcut .......................................................................5-35  
Scan to FTP ........................................................................................................................5-42  
Scanning documents to an FTP server.........................................................................5-42  
Registering an FTP server to a shortcut......................................................................5-45  
Scanning documents using an FTP shortcut ...............................................................5-47  
Reviewing or canceling selected FTP servers ..............................................................5-48  
Registering or editing an FTP server shortcut ............................................................5-49  
Advanced functions ............................................................................................................5-56  
Color ...............................................................................................................................5-56  
Zoom ...............................................................................................................................5-57  
Batch scanning ..............................................................................................................5-59  
Selecting the file format ................................................................................................5-60  
Duplex scanning ............................................................................................................5-61  
Broadcasting ..................................................................................................................5-63  
Attaching additional files to the scanned document....................................................5-64  
Chapter 6  
Reviewing or canceling commands........................................................................................6-1  
Reviewing or canceling commands......................................................................................6-2  
To review or cancel a command ......................................................................................6-2  
Reviewing or canceling parts of a broadcast..................................................................6-4  
Printing a delayed command list....................................................................................6-6  
Printing a stored document.............................................................................................6-6  
View or print the results of a fax transaction................................................................6-8  
Chapter 7  
Copying.........................................................................................................................................7-1  
Before copying ......................................................................................................................7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Document and paper handling .......................................................................................7-2  
Memory overflow message ..............................................................................................7-2  
Making copies.......................................................................................................................7-3  
Making copies ..................................................................................................................7-3  
Setting the next document..............................................................................................7-3  
Copying using both document glass and ADF ...............................................................7-5  
Copy reservation..............................................................................................................7-7  
Basic copy settings ...............................................................................................................7-8  
Document type.................................................................................................................7-8  
Contrast ...........................................................................................................................7-9  
Number of copies .............................................................................................................7-9  
Advanced copy functions....................................................................................................7-10  
Selecting the paper size.................................................................................................7-11  
Zoom ratio ......................................................................................................................7-12  
Automatic sorting..........................................................................................................7-13  
Combine .........................................................................................................................7-14  
Duplex copy....................................................................................................................7-16  
Card Copy ......................................................................................................................7-25  
Specifying the document size to copy ...........................................................................7-27  
Checking the copy print queue ..........................................................................................7-28  
Chapter 8  
PC-Fax function ..........................................................................................................................8-1  
Installing the driver.............................................................................................................8-2  
Sending a PC fax ..................................................................................................................8-3  
Chapter 9  
PC printing ..................................................................................................................................9-1  
Installing the driver.............................................................................................................9-2  
Printing a document from the PC .......................................................................................9-3  
Chapter 10  
Special features ........................................................................................................................10-1  
Soft keys..............................................................................................................................10-2  
Soft key functions ..........................................................................................................10-2  
Programming a soft key ................................................................................................10-5  
Macro keys..........................................................................................................................10-7  
Registering or editing a Macro .....................................................................................10-7  
Deleting a Macro key...................................................................................................10-10  
Changing the Macro key speed...................................................................................10-11  
Editing macro key titles..............................................................................................10-12  
Executing a Macro command......................................................................................10-13  
Program one-touch ...........................................................................................................10-14  
Registering or editing a program one-touch...............................................................10-14  
Deleting a program one-touch.....................................................................................10-19  
How to use a program one-touch ................................................................................10-20  
F-code box feature ............................................................................................................10-21  
F-code introduction......................................................................................................10-21  
Registering or editing an F-code box..........................................................................10-21  
Printing a list of F-code boxes.....................................................................................10-30  
Printing a list of documents stored in F-code boxes ..................................................10-30  
Deleting an empty F-code box.....................................................................................10-30  
Storing a document in a bulletin box .........................................................................10-31  
Printing stored documents .........................................................................................10-33  
Deleting stored documents..........................................................................................10-35  
Sending a document using a subaddress and password............................................10-37  
Polling a document using a subaddress and password..............................................10-38  
Viewing the page counters...............................................................................................10-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking the number of printed pages .....................................................................10-39  
Chapter 11  
Restricting use of the machine .............................................................................................11-1  
Security features ................................................................................................................11-2  
Passcode protection .......................................................................................................11-2  
Security reception..........................................................................................................11-3  
PIN masking..................................................................................................................11-7  
Department management................................................................................................11-13  
Registering the copy charge (Cost management) ......................................................11-13  
Registering department codes ....................................................................................11-14  
Deleting department codes .........................................................................................11-16  
Turning department management On.................................................................................. 11-17  
Using department codes..............................................................................................11-17  
Printing a list of department management settings .................................................11-19  
Resetting the department counter..............................................................................11-20  
Turning department management protection On/Off ...............................................11-21  
Copy protection.................................................................................................................11-22  
Chapter 12  
Machine Settings......................................................................................................................12-1  
Machine setting menu........................................................................................................12-2  
Copy settings ......................................................................................................................12-3  
Accessing the copy settings...........................................................................................12-3  
Fax settings.........................................................................................................................12-4  
Accessing the default fax settings ................................................................................12-4  
Accessing other fax settings..........................................................................................12-5  
Scanner settings.................................................................................................................12-7  
Accessing the default scan settings..............................................................................12-7  
Accessing other scan settings .......................................................................................12-8  
Mail settings.......................................................................................................................12-9  
Accessing the mail settings...........................................................................................12-9  
Management settings.......................................................................................................12-11  
Accessing the management settings...........................................................................12-11  
Paper settings...................................................................................................................12-14  
Accessing the paper settings.......................................................................................12-14  
Chapter 13  
Report & Lists ...........................................................................................................................13-1  
Lists and journal reports ...................................................................................................13-2  
Activity journal...................................................................................................................13-5  
Setting the activity journal...........................................................................................13-5  
Printing the activity journal manually ........................................................................13-6  
Setting the order on the activity journal......................................................................13-7  
Transmission confirmation report.....................................................................................13-8  
Setting the transmission confirmation report..............................................................13-8  
Stored document list ..........................................................................................................13-9  
Erased document notification..........................................................................................13-10  
Chapter 14  
Maintenance & Troubleshooting ..........................................................................................14-1  
Maintenance .......................................................................................................................14-2  
Cleaning tips..................................................................................................................14-2  
Cleaning the scanning area ..........................................................................................14-2  
Cleaning the ADF rollers ..............................................................................................14-3  
Cleaning the drum charge wire and the print head ....................................................14-3  
Replacing the toner cartridge .......................................................................................14-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacing the drum cartridge.......................................................................................14-7  
Troubleshooting..................................................................................................................14-9  
Document jams ..............................................................................................................14-9  
Paper jams ...................................................................................................................14-13  
Displayed error messages ...........................................................................................14-16  
“Check Message” printouts .........................................................................................14-23  
Error codes...................................................................................................................14-24  
Machine errors.............................................................................................................14-26  
Faxing errors................................................................................................................14-26  
Scanning errors............................................................................................................14-27  
Copying errors .............................................................................................................14-28  
PC printing errors ......................................................................................................14-28  
Local Scanner errors ..................................................................................................14-29  
Print quality problems ................................................................................................14-30  
If you cannot solve the problem..................................................................................14-32  
Appendix & Index.....................................................................................................................AI-1  
Specifications......................................................................................................................AI-2  
General...........................................................................................................................AI-2  
Fax..................................................................................................................................AI-3  
Copy................................................................................................................................AI-3  
Printer............................................................................................................................AI-3  
Scanner ..........................................................................................................................AI-4  
Consumable items .........................................................................................................AI-4  
Index ...................................................................................................................................AI-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Regulatory information  
1
2
Customer information  
United States of America  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of FCC rules and the requirements adopted  
by the ACTA. On the rear panel of this equipment is a label that contains, among  
other information, a product identifier in the format US:DKUFA02B002C (for  
F-560/F-520) or US: DKUFA02B003C (for MFX-2030/MFX-1430). If required, this  
number must be provided to the telephone company.  
3
The REN is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected to a  
telephone line. Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not  
ringing in response to an incoming call. In most but not all areas, the sum of RENs  
should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that may be  
connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact the local telephone  
company. The REN for this product is part of the product identifier that has the for-  
mat US: DKUFA02B002C (for F-560/F-520) or US:DKUFA02B003C (for MFX-2030/  
MFX-1430). The digits represented by 02B are the REN without a decimal point.  
4
5
Your fax is designed for use on standard-device telephone lines. The fax connects to  
the telephone line with a standard line called the USOC RJ-11C.  
6
A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises wiring and tele-  
phone network must comply with the applicable FCC Part 68 rules and require-  
ments adopted by the ACTA. A compliant telephone cord and modular plug is  
provided with this product. It is designed to be connected to a compatible modular  
jack that is also compliant. See installation instructions for details.  
7
8
If the equipment MFX-2030/MFX-1430/F-560/F-520 causes harm to the telephone  
network, the telephone company will notify you in advance that temporary dis-  
continuance of service may be required. But if advance notice isn’t practical, the  
telephone company will notify the customer as soon as possible. Also, you will be  
advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC if you believe it is necessary.  
9
The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations  
or procedures that could affect the operation of the equipment. If this happens the  
telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you to make necessary  
modifications to maintain uninterrupted service.  
10  
11  
If trouble is experienced with the equipment MFX-2030/MFX-1430/F-560/F-520,  
see operating instructions for details. For further repair or warranty information,  
please contact Muratec Customer Support Center at 800-347-3296 (from the U.S.  
only). If the equipment is causing harm to the telephone network, the telephone  
company may request that you disconnect the equipment until the problem is  
resolved.  
Connection to party line service is subject to state tariffs. Contact the state public  
utility commission, public service commission or corporation commission for infor-  
mation.  
If your home has specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line,  
ensure the installation of the MFX-2030/MFX-1430/F-560/F-520 does not disable  
your alarm equipment. If you have questions about what will disable alarm equip-  
ment, consult your telephone company or a qualified installer.  
This equipment is hearing aid compatible.  
I-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When programming emergency numbers and/or making test calls to emergency  
numbers:  
1) Remain on the line and briefly explain to the dispatcher the reason for the call.  
2) Perform such activities in the off-peak hours, such as early morning or late  
evenings.  
To protect your product against power surges, we recommend the use of a power  
protection device (Surge arrestor).  
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person  
to use a computer or other electronic device, including FAX machines, to send any  
message unless such message clearly contains in a margin at the top or bottom of  
each transmitted page or on the first page of the transmission, the date and time  
it is sent and an identification of the business or other entity, or other individual  
sending the message and the telephone number of the sending machine or such  
business, other entity, or individual. (The telephone number provided may not be  
a 900 number or any other number for which charges exceed local or long-distance  
transmission charges.)  
For instructions on programming this information into your FAX machine, see  
“Initial setup” on pages 1-14 to 1-22 of this manual.  
FCC Part 15  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A  
digital devices, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to  
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment  
is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can  
radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with  
the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.  
Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful inter-  
ference in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own  
expense.  
Canada  
NOTICE:  
This equipment meets the applicable Industry Canada Terminal Equipment Tech-  
nical Specifications.  
NOTICE:  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) for this terminal equipment is 0.2. The  
REN assigned to each terminal equipment provides an indication of the maximum  
number of terminals allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The termina-  
tion on an interface may consist of any combination of devices subject only to the  
requirement that the sum of the Ringer Equivalence Numbers of all the devices  
does not exceed five.  
Canadian ICES-003  
This Class A digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe A est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du  
Canada.  
I-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Limited warranty  
1
2
This warranty is made by Muratec America, Inc. (hereafter referred to as  
“Muratec”). This warranty is valid only on Muratec products purchased and used  
in the United States of America. This warranty applies to the product only while  
owned and used by the original purchaser (“Customer”). If ownership of the product  
is transferred, this warranty terminates. This warranty does not apply to any prod-  
uct in use for rental purposes.  
This Muratec product is warranted against defects in material and workman-  
ship for ninety (90) days commencing the date of original Customer purchase. If  
the product is defective in material and/or workmanship (normal wear and tear  
excepted) during the warranty period, Muratec or its authorized representative  
will, during Muratec’s established service availability hours, make necessary  
adjustments and repairs, including, at Muratec’s option, installation of replace-  
ment parts. Muratec’s service availability hours are 8:30 am to 5:00 pm (Central  
time) Monday through Friday, excluding Muratec-recognized holidays. Muratec  
will complete the necessary adjustments and repairs within a reasonable time  
period, as dictated by the nature of the problem and by Muratec’s service schedule.  
Replacement parts may have been used and/or reconditioned. Parts that have been  
replaced will remain the property of Muratec. This warranty is subject to the obli-  
gations and exclusions set forth.  
3
4
5
Obligations  
6
1.This warranty will be honored only on presentation of the original dated autho-  
rized Muratec bill of sale or Muratec dealer bill of sale or sales slip to an autho-  
rized Muratec service representative or service center. For the name of your  
authorized service center, contact Muratec (from the United States, call 1-469-  
429-3350; from Canada, check your in-box materials for the number to call).  
7
2.During the warranty period, the Customer must notify Muratec by telephone of  
any defective product material and/or workmanship.  
8
3.Transportation (including prepayment of freight and insurance charges) of the  
product to and from an authorized service center, designated by Muratec, is the  
responsibility of the Customer.  
4.If Muratec provides maintenance or responds to a call which is outside the scope  
of this warranty, such maintenance shall be billed to the Customer at Muratec’s  
then-current rates for maintenance and parts and shall be due and payable in  
full upon receipt of invoice.  
9
Exclusions  
10  
11  
1.This warranty shall not cover a product with missing or altered original identifi-  
cation marks.  
2.This warranty applies only to products that the purchaser has properly installed,  
adjusted and operated in accordance with the instructions set forth in or pro-  
vided with product literature. This warranty does not apply to any product which  
has been subjected to tampering, alteration, misuse, abuse, neglect, improper  
installation or transportation damage. Nor does it apply to costs for any service  
requested for demonstration or to confirm proper operation of this product.  
3.The warranty shall not apply to adjustments, repairs or replacements neces-  
sitated by any cause beyond the control of Muratec (whether foreseeable or not)  
including, but not limited to, any malfunction, defects or failure caused by or  
resulting from any of the following: improper unpacking or installation, unau-  
thorized service or parts, or improper maintenance or cleaning, modification or  
repair by the Customer, accident (including, without limitation, unavoidable  
accidents), fire, flood or other Acts of God, improper telephone or electrical power  
or surges thereof, interconnection with or use of non-compatible equipment or  
supplies (including paper), or placement of the product in an area which does not  
conform to Muratec space, electrical and/or environmental requirements.  
I-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.Muratec will not be required to make adjustments, repairs or replacements if the  
product is installed or used at a location deemed by Muratec to be hazardous to  
health or safety, or if Muratec is not provided with free and reasonable access to  
the product and a telephone during service availability hours, or if the product  
location is not accessible by an authorized Muratec service vehicle.  
EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY SET FORTH ABOVE, AND EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT PROHIBITED BY APPLI-  
CABLE LAW, MURATEC MAKES NO OTHER WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED (INCLUDING, BUT  
NOT LIMITED TO, ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  
PURPOSE, AND ANY WARRANTY ARISING FROM COURSE OF DEALING OR USAGE OF TRADE), AND  
MURATEC EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES NOT STATED HEREIN. IN THE EVENT THE PROD-  
UCT IS NOT FREE FROM DEFECTS AS WARRANTED ABOVE, THE CUSTOMERS SOLE REMEDY SHALL  
BE REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT AS PROVIDED ABOVE. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES SHALL MURATEC  
BE LIABLE TO THE CUSTOMER, OR TO ANY USER, FOR ANY DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY INCIDENTAL  
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, EXPENSES, LOST PROFITS, LOST SAVINGS OR ANY OTHER DAMAGES  
ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE MURATEC PRODUCT, EVEN IF MURATEC OR ITS  
REPRESENTATIVES HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.  
Some States do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential  
damages, and some States do not allow limitations on how long an implied war-  
ranty lasts, so the above limitations or exclusions may not apply to you. This war-  
ranty gives you specific legal rights, and you may also have other rights which vary  
from State to State.  
I-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Precautions  
1
2
Installation precautions  
Keep you machine clean  
Dust buildup can damage your machine. However, do not use a dust  
cover, which can cause overheating.  
Periodically clean your machine as instructed in this manual.  
3
4
Keep your machine away from direct sunlight  
To avoid overheating, set up the machine away from direct sunlight or  
heating unit.  
5
6
Keep your machine level and vibration-free  
To avoid damage to the machine or personal injury, set the machine up  
in a level, vibration-free location.  
7
8
Keep your machine near a phone jack & an AC power outlet  
Your machine uses a standard (modular) telephone jack.  
9
The power cord is about 6.5 feet long when stretched to its limit, and  
the power cord should never be stretched to its limit.  
10  
11  
Keep your machine away from televisions and radios  
Many appliances and office equipment, including televisions, radios,  
copy machines, air conditioners and computers generate electronic  
noise that can interfere with the operation of your machine.  
Avoid extreme high / low temperatures  
Use your machine within the temperature range of 10 °C to 32 °C (50  
°F to 89.6 °F).  
50 F to 89.6 F  
(
)
10 C to 32 C  
I-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power requirements  
Use a standard AC 120 V outlet  
Use a standard three-pronged 120 V electrical outlet to power your  
machine. Using any other electrical outlet could damage your machine.  
AC 120V  
Do not share an extension cord connector with other plugs  
This could cause electrical shock.  
Do not share an outlet with a large appliance  
High-consumption appliances such as refrigerators and air condition-  
ers can cause “draw-downs” which could damage your machine.  
Plug in the power cord  
Plug the power cord carefully and completely into a wall outlet. Do not  
leave any portion of the electrical cord’s metal plugs exposed. Doing so  
could cause a fire and increases the risk of electrical shock.  
Make sure the outlet is not controlled by a wall switch  
If it is, you will risk occasional shutoffs to the machine, causing you to lose fax message.  
Use an electrical surge suppressor, preferably one which guards both telephone and  
electrical lines. This device helps to shield your machine from damaging high-voltage electrical  
surges.  
I-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Space requirements  
1
2
To ensure proper ventilation and easy operation, set up the machine in an area that meets the  
minimum requirements for clearance as illustrated below.  
100 mm  
(40 inches)  
100 mm  
(40 inches)  
713 mm  
813 mm  
(181 inches) (221 inches)  
872 mm  
772 mm  
(344 inches) (304 inches)  
3
4
50 mm  
(20 inches)  
50 mm  
(20 inches)  
753 mm (297 inches)  
853 mm (337 inches)  
In order to enable easy machine maintenance and replacement of consumables,  
maintain an adequate amount of space around the machine.  
NOTE:  
5
When lifting the machine, be sure to grab the handles on the left and right  
sides of the cassette tray.  
6
General precautions  
7
Never disassemble your machine  
Disassembling your machine can cause serious injury to you and  
damage to your machine. If service is required, contact your Muratec  
dealer.  
8
9
Never handle your machine or power cord with wet hands  
10  
11  
Never touch your machine or power cord if your hands are wet.  
During electrical storms, disconnect the plug from the outlet  
Electrical storms can cause electrical shock or damage to the machine.  
I-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keep your machine dry and away from liquids  
Keep liquids and metal pins or other objects away from your machine.  
If something falls into the machine, immediately turn OFF the power  
switch, unplug the power cord from the power outlet, and then contact  
your Muratec dealer.  
Do not rest furniture or other equipment on the power cord  
Do not put anything on or over the electrical power cord, and do not  
route the power cord under rugs or carpets. Doing so can damage the  
power cord and/or the machine, causing fire or electrical shock.  
Allow clearance around the outlet  
Do not stack boxes or furniture around the outlet.  
Be careful not to damage the display  
Never push down on the display with force, and never use a hard or  
pointed object to make a selection in the display.  
Transporting the Machine  
If you need to transport the machine over a long distance, consult your Muratec dealer.  
Storing and handling the toner and drum cartridges  
To avoid damage to your machine and to assure the best performance possible, follow these  
guidelines when storing and handling the toner and drum cartridges:  
Use supplies manufactured specifically for Muratec machines  
Using toner and drum cartridges or other supplies that are not manufactured specifically for  
your machine may affect the operation of your machine.  
Storing the cartridges  
Store the cartridges in a location that meets the following requirements:  
• Free from direct sunlight  
• Away from dusty conditions  
• Away from floppy disks or other computer media, computer displays, or other materials  
sensitive to magnetic fields.  
• Away from high humidity  
• Do not stand the cartridge on its end and do not store it upside down.  
• Do not open the protective bag containing the cartridge until you are ready to install the  
cartridge.  
I-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cartridge handling  
Do not burn toner cartridges  
1
2
Toner powder is extremely flammable. Exposure to flame can cause the toner cartridge to  
burn or explode, causing serious injury.  
• Keep cartridges away from water and oil.  
• Do not expose cartridges to direct sunlight.  
• Do not subject cartridges to static or electrical shock.  
CAUTION: Be careful not to get the toner powder in your eyes. If toner powder gets in your  
3
eyes, immediately flush your eyes with water and seek medical assistance.  
4
Legal restrictions on copying  
Certain types of documents cannot be duplicated with the intent to pass copies of such docu-  
ments off as the originals.  
5
The following is not a complete list, but is meant to be used as a guide to responsible copying.  
Financial instruments  
• Personal checks  
6
• Travelers checks  
• Money orders  
7
• Certificates of deposit  
• Bonds or other certificates of indebtedness  
• Stock certificates  
8
Legal documents  
• Food stamps  
• Postage stamps (canceled or uncanceled)  
• Checks or drafts drawn by government agencies  
• Internal revenue stamps (canceled or uncanceled)  
• Passports  
• Immigration papers  
• Motor vehicle licenses and titles  
• House and property titles and deeds  
9
10  
11  
General  
• Identification cards, badges, or insignias  
• Copyrighted works without permission of the copyright owner  
In addition, it is prohibited under any circumstances to copy domestic or foreign currencies, or  
works of art, without permission of the copyright owner.  
If you are unsure about the legal restrictions regarding the duplication of a document, consult  
with legal counsel.  
I-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caution labels  
The caution labels are attached to the machine as shown below, to avoid any serious  
injury.  
I-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Symbols and terms  
1
2
In this manual, the following symbols, terms and abbreviations are used. Please familiarize  
yourself with them.  
WARNING  
CAUTION  
This symbol indicates how to avoid serious or potentially fatal injuries.  
This symbol indicates how to avoid personal injury.  
3
IMPORTANT:  
This instruction describes conditions or incorrect operations that could  
cause damage to your machine.  
4
NOTE:  
A note describes helpful hints, restrictions and how to avoid problems.  
The names of the keys on the control panel.  
Items that appear on the display.  
[
]
5
Document  
Original sheet(s) of paper you send, copy and scan on your machine.  
Paper to be printed on.  
Paper  
Tx  
6
Denotes sending.  
Rx  
,
Denotes receiving.  
7
Shows the direction of the document and paper.  
Direction mark  
Document placed on the ADF or  
document glass*  
Paper loaded in the  
paper cassette  
8
or Nothing  
Ex.) Letter  
9
10  
11  
Ex.) Half-letter  
* The document glass is available only for MFX-2030/MFX-1430 model.  
I-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Main Features  
Copy  
Card Copy (MFX-2030/1430 only) (see page 7-25)  
Need to copy both sides of an id card, driver’s license or check? Use the Card Copy  
mode to quickly capture card or check-size images onto a single sheet.  
Combine Copy (See page 7-14)  
Up to four separate images can be combined onto a single document, reducing  
paper consumption and consumable usage.  
Copy/Fax  
Macro Program (See page 10-7)  
Programming copy jobs can be tedious, especially when you want to customize a job  
requiring several steps. If you regularly perform a job that requires multiple steps  
you can consolidate these steps into a macro, simplifying the process into a one-  
touch operation.  
Department Codes (See page 11-13)  
You can easily track machine usage and restrict machine access by activating the  
department code feature. Once activated, the machine will ask for a valid depart-  
ment code prior to access. A monetary cost can also be assigned to each job, making  
interoffice billing a snap.  
Duplex Printing (See page 7-16)  
Quickly convert one-sided originals into two-sided output by utilizing duplex print-  
ing. For additional paper and cost savings receive your incoming faxes as two-sided  
printouts.  
* For duplex printing with F-520/MFX-1430, the optional duplex printing unit is  
required.  
I-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copy/Fax/Scan  
1
2
Soft Keys (See page 10-2)  
Soft keys allow one-touch access to important machine features. The keys on the  
default display are customizable, meaning you can set the features you use fre-  
quently onto the default display for easy access.  
3
4
5
* This is the screen shown in the F-560/F-520 model.  
6
Energy Save Mode (See page 1-23)  
Energy Save mode assists in reducing energy consumption and total operat-  
ing costs. If the machine is left idle for a “user-determined” amount of time, the  
machine will automatically enter energy save mode.  
7
8
9
10  
11  
80 sheet ADF  
While it’s true most fax, copy and scan jobs contain less than 10 pages, you may  
have the occasional need to perform larger jobs. With the standard 80-sheet ADF  
large jobs do not have to be broken up, thus increasing efficiency.  
I-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax  
Dual Line Option  
High-volume fax users will appreciate the ability to send and receive fax documents  
at the same time, greatly increasing office efficiency.  
Security Reception (See page 11-3)  
Security reception allows you to receive documents into password protected storage  
boxes. This insures that documents are only viewed by authorized personnel.  
Batch Transmission (See page 3-35)  
Scan documents into batch transmission storage boxes and schedule the trans-  
mission time for off-peak hours, both reducing operating costs and allowing the  
machine to be available during peak business hours.  
Send  
Fax Forwarding  
Skipping town? Simply turn on the fax forwarding feature and have all inbound  
documents routed to a remote fax number. (See page 3-51.) Using a web browser,  
you can set up an advanced forwarding system. (See page 5-17 of the “Network  
guide”.)  
Receive  
Forwarding  
Transmission Confirmation Report (See page 13-8)  
Automatically generate a transmission confirmation report to confirm whether or  
not your fax document reached the remote machine successfully.  
I-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PC-Faxing (See page 8-1)  
Why move if you don’t have to? Use the PC fax application to quickly send docu-  
1
2
ments from your desktop to remote fax machines. The intuitive address book is easy  
to navigate to find a destination.  
3
Send  
4
5
Mail  
MDN/DSN Reporting (See “Network Guide”)  
When sending e-mail you may request a delivery status notification (DSN) which  
6
confirms whether the mail was received and/or a message disposition notification  
(MDN) which confirms whether the mail was read.  
7
Fax/Mail  
8
Address Book (See page 2-1)  
Store important contact information into your machines address book for one-touch  
recall. Each contact can have a fax number, e-mail address and group(s) associated  
with them.  
9
Mixed Broadcasting (See page 3-24)  
Your machine can quickly send to both e-mail and fax destinations at the same  
time, eliminating the need to manually send each document.  
10  
11  
Send  
I-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directory Searching (LDAP) (See page 5-17)  
Finding important contacts has never been easier. Press the [Search] on the display  
to quickly locate contacts, whether they reside in the machine-side address book or  
on a shared company directory.  
Personal/Shared Directories  
With the OfficeBridge expansion kit installed you can keep personal contacts sepa-  
rate from the general directory. This allows for quick, secure access to your private  
contact list.  
Scan  
Network Scanning (See page 5-1)  
Your machine can seamlessly convert hardcopy monochrome and color documents  
into digital files for storage and distribution. A feature unique to your machine  
is the ability to browse your internal network and seamlessly deliver documents  
directly into folder locations.  
PH  
PH  
ON  
E1  
E2  
ON  
LIN  
E
File Name and Format (See page 4-13, 5-6, 5-60)  
Changing the file name and format when scanning has never been easier. You can  
name each file prior to scanning using an intuitive QWERTY keypad, making file  
retrieval easy. You may also change the file format (TIFF/PDF/JPEG) in the scan  
menu, insuring that each scan meets your archiving/retrieval requirements.  
I-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General  
1
2
Network Printing (See page 9-1)  
You’re not training for the Olympics, so why run a marathon every time you need to  
make a copy? The convenient network printing function is standard and allows you  
to decentralize printing from the copy room to your small workgroup.  
3
4
PH  
PH  
ON  
E1  
E2  
ON  
LIN  
E
5
Local Printing/Scanning (See page 9-1)  
6
Your machines small footprint is perfect for the small office / home office, an envi-  
ronment that normally does not have a network set-up. That’s why we offer direct  
printing and color scanning via the USB port, bypassing the need for network con-  
nectivity.  
7
8
PH  
PH  
ON  
E1  
E2  
ON  
LIN  
E
9
10  
11  
Paper Handling  
An additional 500-sheet cassette is available as an option, bringing the total capac-  
ity to 1,050 sheets. This accommodates offices that utilize both letter and legal-  
sized paper, as well as applications that use large volumes of letter.  
I-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
I-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
1
Getting Started  
Machine overview ..................................................................................1-2  
Machine layout................................................................................1-2  
Control panel overview...................................................................1-3  
Operating tips ........................................................................................1-4  
Changing modes..............................................................................1-4  
Operating the display.....................................................................1-4  
Display description .........................................................................1-4  
Key displays and functions ............................................................1-9  
Entering characters......................................................................1-10  
Memory back-up ...........................................................................1-13  
Initial setup..........................................................................................1-14  
Clearing stored settings ...............................................................1-14  
Getting started..............................................................................1-15  
Specifying the initial settings ......................................................1-16  
Using the Energy save mode........................................................1-23  
Document and paper handling............................................................1-24  
Document handling ......................................................................1-24  
Paper handling..............................................................................1-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Machine overview  
Machine layout  
Automatic  
document feeder  
(ADF)  
Document  
guides  
Document  
tray  
Document  
exit tray  
Control panel  
Bypass tray  
Paper cassette  
2nd side cover  
1st side cover  
2nd paper cassette  
(Option)  
Front cover  
Platen cover  
Paper level  
Indicator  
Telephone  
Connectors  
P
H
O
O
N
E
E
1
P
H
N
2
The document glass  
is available only for  
L
I
N
E
the MFX-2030/MFX-1430.  
Document glass  
Second phone line  
(Option)  
Paper exit tray  
USB connector  
PH  
PH  
O
N
N
E1  
O
Network connector  
E2  
L
IN  
E
AC power jack  
Power switch  
1-2  
GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Control panel overview  
5 4  
8
9
11  
1
1
2
2
3
6
13  
14  
3
4
5
7
10  
12  
Display Contrast  
1
6
This adjusts the brightness of the display.  
Mode keys  
2
3
Press these keys to toggle between modes. The key will be highlighted after it is pressed.  
7
Online  
Shows whether or not the PC printing function is available.  
For details of PC printing, see the PDF manual on the Printer & Scanner Manual [CD].  
8
Alarm lamp  
Lights when an error occurs.  
Comm. lamp  
4
5
9
Lights when the machine is communicating with another machine.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Memory Receive lamp  
6
Lights when the machine is out of paper and documents are being stored into memory.  
Display  
7
Displays machine status, interactive displays, and touch keys for selecting all functions.  
Setting  
8
Press this key to view/edit machine default settings.  
Reset  
9
Returns the menu to the standby mode and resets all settings back to their defaults.  
Energy Save  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
Press this to put the machine into the energy save mode and reduce power consumption.  
Numeric keys  
Use these keys to enter numerical values, such as fax/phone numbers.  
Start  
Executes the operation.  
Stop  
Stops the machine’s operation. To stop a fax transmission, press [Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.].  
Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.  
Press this to cancel or review stored jobs, or to review the results of a communication.  
GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-3  
Operating tips  
Changing modes  
You can switch to the Copy, Fax or Scan standby mode by pressing the mode keys.  
NOTE: You cannot switch the mode in any of the following cases:  
• While scanning a document.  
• During a real time transmission.  
Operating the display  
To select a function or to set a setting, lightly touch the desired function or setting  
shown on the display.  
CAUTION: Never push down on the display with force, and never use a hard or pointed  
object to make a selection in the display.  
Display description  
You can directly touch keys on the control panel for machine operation.  
Functions and values can be changed by touching the keys or tabs shown on the  
display.  
Copy standby mode  
Message Area  
Number of sets  
Memory Indicator  
Soft Keys  
Others  
Main Unit Icon  
Name  
Function  
Message Area  
Displays the machine’s current status, operation instructions,  
error messages and other information.  
Number of sets Indicates the print quantity entered from the control panel.  
Memory  
Indicator  
Indicates the remaining memory available for the next opera-  
tion.  
Main Unit Icon Displays the status of the main unit. This can also be used to  
select the cassette/bypass tray for a copy job.  
Soft Keys  
Displays five functions frequently used. You can assign other  
functions to soft key according your needs. (See “Soft key” on  
page 10-2.)  
Others  
Press this to display the various copy functions.  
1-4  
GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax standby mode  
Message Area  
Standby Status  
Time Display and Memory  
1
2
Soft Keys  
Others  
3
Address Book  
4
5
Name  
Function  
Message Area  
Displays the machine’s current status, operation instructions,  
error messages and other information.  
6
Standby Status Displays the fax reception mode.  
7
Time Display  
and Memory  
Displays the current date, time and amount of fax memory  
available.  
8
Address Book  
Soft Keys  
Displays the registered destinations.  
Displays five functions frequently used. You can assign other  
functions to soft key according your needs. (See “Soft key” on  
page 10-2.)  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Others  
Search  
Press this to display the various fax functions.  
Press this to search the destination from your Address Book or  
your LDAP server.  
Index  
Displays the destinations in alphabetical or group or numeric  
order.  
Add/Edit  
Adds or edits the destination.  
GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-5  
Scan standby mode (scan to e-mail)  
Message Area  
Time Display and Memory  
Soft Keys  
Others  
Address Book  
Name  
Function  
Message Area  
Displays the machine’s current status, operation instructions,  
error messages and other information.  
Time Display  
and Memory  
Displays the current date, time and amount of scan memory  
available.  
Address Book  
Soft Keys  
Displays the registered destinations.  
Displays five functions frequently used. You can assign other  
functions to soft key according your needs. (See “Soft key” on  
page 10-2.)  
Others  
Search  
Press this to display the various scan functions.  
Press this to search the destination from your Address Book or  
your LDAP server.  
Index  
Displays the destinations in alphabetical or group or numeric  
order.  
Add/Edit  
Adds or edits the destination.  
1-6  
GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan standby mode (scan to folder)  
Message Area  
Time Display and Memory  
1
2
Soft Keys  
Others  
3
Shortcut List  
4
5
Name  
Function  
Message Area  
Displays the machine’s current status, operation instructions,  
error messages and other information.  
6
Time Display  
and Memory  
Displays the current date, time and amount of scan memory  
available.  
7
Shortcut List  
Soft Keys  
Displays the registered folder shortcuts.  
8
Displays five functions frequently used. You can assign other  
functions to soft key according your needs. (See “Soft key” on  
page 10-2.)  
9
Others  
Browse  
Press this to display the various scan functions.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press this to browse through the network. Used to save the  
scanned image to your desired folder.  
Add/Edit  
Adds or edits the folder shortcuts.  
GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-7  
Scan standby mode (scan to FTP)  
Message Area  
Time Display and Memory  
Soft Keys  
Others  
Shortcut List  
Name  
Function  
Message Area  
Displays the machine’s current status, operation instructions,  
error messages and other information.  
Time Display  
and Memory  
Displays the current date, time and amount of scan memory  
available.  
Shortcut List  
Soft Keys  
Displays the registered FTP server shortcuts.  
Displays five functions frequently used. You can assign other  
functions to soft key according your needs. (See “Soft key” on  
page 10-2.)  
Others  
Host  
Press this to display the various scan functions.  
Press this to enter the FTP server’s link. Used to save the  
scanned image to your desired FTP server.  
Add/Edit  
Adds or edits the FTP server shortcuts.  
1-8  
GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Key displays and functions  
Keys on the display  
To set a function, press this key to open the setting display. Some keys switch  
ON/OFF by simply touching them. When another setting is required to be set first  
or when the function cannot be combined with another function, the key will be  
grayed-out and cannot be selected. Also, the selected key will be highlighted.  
1
Setting option  
2
<When a key cannot be selected>  
3
<Before selection>  
<After selection>  
4
5
Cursor keys, [Prev] & [Next], [Page Up] & [Page Down]  
6
These keys are used when entering numbers or selecting functions. They are also  
used when changing displays.  
<Number Entry>  
<Display Change>  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
[Back], [Cancel], [Enter]  
[Back]........Goes back to the previous menu level.  
[Cancel].....Returns you to the default display without resetting previously regis-  
tered functions.  
[Enter].......Sets the function or number specified on the display.  
GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1-9  
Entering characters  
QWERTY keypad  
Number of entered charac-  
ters /Number of characters  
that can be entered  
This displays the number of  
characters that can be entered  
and the number of characters  
entered so far.  
Edit window  
This displays the  
entered charac-  
ters.  
Cursor keys  
They move the character entry  
position.  
Mode selection keys  
Return key  
They change the type of  
characters that are be-  
ing entered.  
Press this to insert a line  
break while entering text in  
cover page or e-mail subject.  
Delete  
Press this to delete characters.  
1-10 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering alpha characters  
Select the characters to be entered from the QWERTY keypad.  
1
2
3
4
Upper and lower case characters  
Press [Lower] to enter the lower case letters.  
Press [Upper] to enter the upper case letters.  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Entering symbols and special characters  
Select [Symbol] to enter the symbol or special characters.  
• The “_”, “.”, “@” and “.com” can be entered in the alpha entry display.  
GETTING STARTED 1-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The symbols that can be entered are as follows.  
Entering numbers  
Using the numeric keys  
Enter numbers by pressing the numeric keys.  
Using the QWERTY keypad  
Select the numbers to be entered from the QWERTY keypad.  
1-12 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering spaces  
To enter a space, press [Space] while entering.  
1
2
3
4
Deleting/Inserting characters  
5
To delete a character, use [ ] [ ] to move the cursor to the character you want to  
delete, and then press [Delete].  
To insert a character, use [ ] [ ] to move the cursor to the insert position and  
enter the character.  
6
NOTE: The last entered character can be deleted by pressing [Delete].  
7
8
Memory back-up  
9
Image data stored in memory is held under the following conditions, even if a power  
failure occurs or the machine is shut down.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• Image data stored in memory is held for the following period of time. Note that  
the power of the machine should be turned ON for at least 24 hours beforehand.  
• The time it takes for data back-up depends on the size of the memory.  
8 MB : Approx. 72 hours (standard memory)  
40 MB: Approx. 24 hours (if the 32 MB Memory Extension kit is installed)  
When you turn the power ON after it is OFF for a long period, the Time Setting  
display may appear. In this case, be sure to perform the time setting before using  
the machine. You cannot use the machine without the time setting.  
GETTING STARTED 1-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial setup  
Clearing stored settings  
Before using your machine, clear the built-in user data. This insures that the  
memory will hold only your settings.  
IMPORTANT:After specifying the initial settings, do not clear the memory again without  
consulting your Muratec dealer.  
To clear the machine’s memory:  
Press [Setting], [ ], [0], [2].  
1
If you want to clear the memory, press [Yes].  
If you do not want to clear the memory, press [No].  
2
1-14 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
In some countries you are required by law to indicate your name and fax number  
on every fax you send.  
YOU MUST THEREFORE STORE YOUR NAME (OR COMPANY NAME)  
AND FAX NUMBER IN YOUR MACHINE BEFORE USING IT.  
Every fax page you send arrives at the receiving machine with a single line of  
text at the very top of the page. This text lists a name, called the Transmit Termi-  
nal Identifier (TTI), and a fax number.  
1
2
Under “Specifying the initial settings” next page, you can setup the following items  
including your name and fax number.  
• Language  
3
• Current date and time  
• Automatic daylight saving time detection  
• Broadcasting  
4
• Phone dial type  
5
• Fax reception mode  
• Dial tone detection  
• TTI 1 / TTI 2 / TTI 3  
• Default TTI  
Your fax number  
• Time zone  
6
7
8
These settings can be changed at any time.  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
GETTING STARTED 1-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifying the initial settings  
If you press [Reset] during the initial setup, your machine will return to the  
standby mode. You can save the settings you have made by selecting [Enter] as  
shown below.  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [User Install].  
2
The user install list is displayed.  
3
Set the desired settings. (See page 1-17 to 1-22)  
4
After setting all the items, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
Print out the Fax Settings List from the [List] menu to insure that your set-  
tings are correct. (See page 12-4)  
5
1-16 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Language  
Select the machine’s display language - English, French or Spanish. The selected  
language will be applied to the list printouts as well.  
Press [Language].  
1
Languages available to use is displayed.  
1
Select the language.  
2
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
2
NOTE: Some versions do not support the language conversion.  
3
Date & Time  
Set the current time in the order of year (4 digits), month (2 digits), day (2 digits),  
hour (12-hour clock, 2 digits), and minutes (2 digits).  
4
Press [Time Setting].  
1
5
Use [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the current date and time.  
2
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
GETTING STARTED 1-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Daylight savings  
Select whether to activate the daylight savings feature.  
Press [Set Daylight Saving].  
1
2
Select [ON] to activate daylight savings, and [OFF] to deactivate it.  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
Broadcasting  
Set the broadcast transmission option.  
If you select [ON], you need to select a destination(s) and press [Start] in order to  
transmit faxes.  
If you select [OFF], you can transmit faxes by simply touching the destination key.  
Press [Broadcast].  
1
Select [ON] or [OFF].  
2
If you select [ON], you can select two or more destinations from the address  
book at a transmission.  
If you select [OFF], the transmission will immediately start when you press a  
destination from the address book.  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
1-18 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Phone dialing type  
Set the dialing type needed for the fax machine, either “Tone” or “Pulse”.  
Press [Comm. Line].  
1
2
Select the dialing type.  
1
2
3
4
5
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
6
Fax reception mode  
Select the reception mode that best matches the machine usage.  
7
Press [Reception Mode].  
1
2
8
Select the reception mode. (For description of the reception modes, see “Select-  
ing the reception mode” on page 3-15.)  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
GETTING STARTED 1-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial tone detection  
Select if you set the dial tone detection.  
Select [OFF] normally.  
Press [DialTone Detect].  
1
Select [ON] to detect the dial tone, and [OFF] if the detection is not required.  
2
If you select [ON], you cannot transmit the faxes through the line that does not  
aquire the dial tone.  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
TTI (your name)  
Three types of TTI (Transmit Terminal Indentifier) can be set.  
Press [TTI Enter/Edit].  
1
Press [TTI 1].  
2
Enter the TTI.  
3
Press [Enter] after the entry to save it.  
(For description of character entry, see “Entering characters” on page 1-10.)  
4
In the same way, you can enter the TTI 2 and TTI 3.  
5
1-20 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting the default TTI  
Select the TTI that will be used most often.  
Press [Default TTI].  
1
2
Select the TTI to be shown at the top of faxes you send.  
1
2
3
4
5
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
6
Entering your fax number  
Press [TTI Number].  
1
7
Use the numeric key to enter the TTI number (your fax machine’s phone num-  
ber).  
2
8
This number can contain up to 20 characters.  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• To enter “+” symbol before your country code, press [+].  
• To make long numbers easier to read, press [-] to enter it.  
• To erase a number, press [Clear].  
• To change just one number, press [ ] or [ ] to move the cursor then press  
[Clear] to erase the number. Then re-enter the correct number.  
GETTING STARTED 1-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Time Zone  
“Time zones” refer to the difference in time (up to ±12 hours) between countries  
from the Greenwich Observatory in England, which is taken to be standard time,  
and to regions that use the same difference.  
Press [Time Zone].  
1
Use the numeric keys to enter your time zone.  
2
Press these keys to move the cursor.  
Press this key to change between “+”  
and “-”.  
Example of Time Zone:  
(GMT –11:00) Midway Island  
(GMT –10:00) Hawaii  
(GMT –09:00) Alaska  
(GMT –08:00) Pacific Time (US & Canada)  
(GMT –07:00) Mountain Time (US & Canada)  
(GMT –06:00) Central Time (US & Canada)  
(GMT –05:00) Eastern Time (US & Canada)  
(GMT –04:00) Atlantic Time (Canada)  
(GMT –03:30) Newfoundland  
(GMT) Greenwich Mean Time: Dublin, Edinburgh, Lisbon, London  
(GMT +01:00) Amsterdam, Berlin, Bern, Rome, Stockholm, Vienna  
(GMT +01:00) Belgrade, Bratislava, Budapest, Ljubljana, Prague  
(GMT +01:00) Brussels, Copenhagen, Madrid, Paris  
(GMT +09:00) Osaka, Sapporo, Tokyo, Seoul  
(GMT +10:00) Guam  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
1-22 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Energy save mode  
When the machine has been idle for a predetermined amount of time, the Energy  
Save mode will activate to conserve power. By default, the machine will automati-  
cally enter the Energy Save mode after 5 minutes of idle time.  
While the Energy Save mode:  
• The machine stops the pre-heating for printing and turn off the display.  
(However, the scanner lamp will not shut off.)  
1
• [Energy Save] lights in green to indicates that the machine is in the Energy  
Save mode.  
• Press [Energy Save] to recover from the Energy Save mode.  
2
3
NOTE: • The Energy Save mode will not activate in the following cases, even if you  
press [Energy Save].  
4
• While scanning documents  
• When a document is set in the ADF  
*Energy Save mode will not activate when “Calibrating Scanner” appears in  
the display.  
5
• When the print error occurs (ex: out-of-paper status, paper jam)  
• When the telephone line is used  
• When cooling fan is rotating  
• For the Energy Save Mode setting, see page 12-12.  
• Only the display backlight will be turned out in the following cases.  
6
7
• When the machine is not used for more than 10 minutes. (The backlight  
may not be turned out in some cases, such as while scanning documents.)  
8
• When printing received documents of fax/internet fax, during PC printing,  
or when automatically printing lists (ex: check message) in the Energy Save  
mode.  
9
To turn on the backlight, press any key on the display or on the control panel.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
GETTING STARTED 1-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Document and paper handling  
Document handling  
Be sure to read the following guidelines before you begin faxing, copying or scan-  
ning.  
Acceptable documents  
ADF  
Single-sheet  
Multiple-sheet  
Size  
(W × L)  
Max. 8.5 × 35.43 in.*  
(216 × 900 mm)*  
Min. 4.72 × 3.94 in.  
(120 × 100 mm)  
Max. 8.5 × 14 in.  
(216 × 356 mm)  
Min. 8.5 × 5.49 in.  
(216 × 139.5 mm)  
Quantity  
1 sheet  
Max. 80 sheets of Letter-,  
Legal-, or Half-letter  
- size sheets  
(75 g/m2 or 20lb. paper)  
Weight  
35.0 to 128.0 g/m2  
0.05 to 0.15 mm  
Plain paper  
52.0 to 105.0 g/m2  
0.07 to 0.12 mm  
Plain paper  
Thickness  
Document  
type  
* Real time transmission with super-fine resolution, 8.5 × 14 in. (216 × 356 mm).  
Document glass  
The document glass is available only for MFX-2030/MFX-1430 model.  
Size  
(W × L)  
Max. 8.5 × 14 in.  
(216 × 356 mm)  
Quantity  
Weight  
1 sheet  
Thickness  
Document  
type  
Plain paper and other  
types of documents.  
Items to avoid  
To prevent jams and damage to the automatic document feeder, do not use the fol-  
lowing:  
• Folded, curled, torn, wrinkled or very thin pages  
• Documents with staples, glue, tape, paper clips or still-wet correction fluid  
• “Sticky notes” (or documents with “sticky notes” attached)  
• Cardboard, newspaper or fabric  
• Pages with duplicating carbon on either side  
• Credit cards or any small, thick items  
• OHP transparency film  
1-24 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scanning area  
The scanned area is shown below.  
Fax : 0.1 in. (2.5 mm)  
Copy, Scan : 0 in. (0 mm)  
Letter  
Legal  
1
2
Scanned area  
Fax  
: 0.08 in. (2.0 mm)  
3
Copy, Scan : 0 in. (0 mm)  
Fax  
: 8.2 in. (208 mm)  
4
Copy, Scan : 8.5 in. (216 mm)  
5
Loading documents in the ADF  
6
Insert the documents face-up, top edge first.  
1
2
7
Adjust the document guides to the document  
size.  
8
Loading the document on the document glass  
9
Make sure there is no documents in the ADF.  
1
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Lift the platen cover.  
2
Face down the document and place it on the  
3
document glass. The document should be  
aligned to the upper left corner.  
Gently close the platen cover.  
4
IMPORTANT:When copying a bound document, such as a book, the copied image may contain  
some black areas. To reduce this effect, hold down the document to prevent its  
bound part from rising. However, do not press too strongly. This may break the  
document glass and cause an injury.  
GETTING STARTED 1-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper handling  
Acceptable paper sizes  
Paper cassette  
Paper type  
Paper size  
Quantity  
Plain paper  
(weight: 20–24 lbs.)  
500 sheets  
(weight: 20 lbs.)  
Letter, Legal, Half-letter  
Bypass tray  
Paper type  
Paper size  
Quantity  
Plain paper  
(weight: 20–28 lbs.)  
50 sheets  
(weight: 20 lbs.)  
Letter, Legal, Half-letter , Executive  
A4, A5, A5 , A6, F4,  
Custom sizes  
1 sheet  
• Width: 3.8 to 8.5 in. (97 to 216 mm)  
• Length: 5.5 to 14 in. (140 to 356 mm)  
Envelopes  
DL: 4.33 × 8.66 in. (110 × 220 mm)  
Com#10: 4.125 × 9.5 in. (105 × 241 mm)  
Monarch: 3.875 × 7.5 in. (98.4 × 190.5 mm)  
1 envelope  
Postcard  
3.94 × 5.83 in. (100 × 148 mm)  
Letter  
20 sheets  
20 sheets  
Transparency  
• Custom-sized paper can be used for PC printing only.  
• Do not use envelopes with double flaps or pressure seals since these do not feed  
properly.  
• If using a transparency (OHP) film, be sure that the film does not have a paper  
backing and/or leading strip. If it does, remove the paper backing and/or strip  
before loading. Only the film should go in, film with paper backing or a leading  
strip should not be fed.  
Duplex printing  
The duplex printing unit is required in order to perform two-sided printing.  
Paper type  
Paper size  
Plain paper  
(weight: 20–24 lbs.)  
Letter, Legal, A4, F4  
Paper to avoid:  
To prevent jams and damage to your machine, do not use the following:  
• Creased paper  
• Wrinkled paper  
• Folded paper  
• Curled paper  
• Torn paper  
• Very thick paper  
• Paper previously printed on by a printer  
• Paper with holes  
• Envelopes with pressure seals  
• Extremely shiny or highly textured paper  
• Carbon paper  
• Moist paper  
• Very thin paper  
1-26 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printable area  
The printable area is shown below.  
0.12 in. (3 mm)  
1
2
Printable area  
0.12 in. (3 mm)  
3
0.12 in. (3 mm) 0.12 in. (3 mm)  
4
Loading paper into the paper cassettes  
5
NOTE: After you load paper into the paper cassettes, you need to set the paper size on  
the control panel. See “Setting of the paper size” on page 1-30.  
6
Pull the handle to open the paper cassette.  
1
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press down the paper lifting plate until it locks in position.  
2
Adjust the rear paper guide to the desired paper length.  
3
GETTING STARTED 1-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Load the paper into the cassette.  
• Before you insert paper in the cassette, stack it so the leading edge and sides  
of the paper are even.  
4
• Do not stack the paper over the limit mark inside of the cassette.  
NOTE: To prevent paper jams, do not refill the paper cassette without first removing any  
remaining paper. In other words, do not just add sheets to an already-loaded stack.  
Pinch the side paper guide and adjust to the width of the stack.  
5
Close the paper cassette.  
6
After loading paper in the paper cassette, you need to set the paper size.  
(See “Setting the paper size” on page 1-30.)  
7
Attach the paper size sticker supplied with your machine to the front of the  
cassette.  
8
1-28 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper into the bypass tray  
When you need to use a paper size that is not currently loaded in the paper cas-  
sette, or when you want to print on an envelope, transparency film or custom sized  
paper, use the bypass tray.  
NOTE: Only use print media specified under “Acceptable paper sizes” on page 1-26 to  
avoid paper jams and print quality problems.  
1
Open the bypass tray on the right side of your machine. Unfold the paper sup-  
port extension.  
1
2
3
4
5
To set the paper, 1) raise the flapper release lever 2) load paper until it comes to  
a stop.  
2
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
1) Adjust the paper guides to fit the paper, 2) then lower the flapper release  
lever.  
3
GETTING STARTED 1-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
After loading paper into the bypass tray, you need to set the correct paper size.  
(See “Setting the paper size,” below.)  
4
NOTE: You can also set the paper size for bypass tray by pressing [Bypass] in the Copy  
standby mode.  
Setting the paper size  
Default setting: 1st cassette: Letter, 2nd cassette (option): Letter, Bypass Tray: Letter  
After loading paper into the paper cassette/bypass tray, you need to set the correct  
paper size on the control panel by using the following procedure.  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Paper Settings].  
2
Setting the paper type for the 1st cassette  
Press [Cassette 1].  
3
1-30 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select the paper size for the first cassette.  
4
1
2
3
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
5
4
Setting the paper size for the 2nd cassette  
5
Press [Cassette 2].  
3
Select the paper size for the second cassette.  
6
4
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
5
GETTING STARTED 1-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting bypass tray paper  
Press [Bypass].  
3
Select the paper size for the bypass tray.  
4
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
5
6
Press [Reset] to exit and return to the standby mode.  
1-32 GETTING STARTED  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
2
Using the Address Book  
The address book....................................................................................2-2  
The address book display ...............................................................2-2  
Special dialing characters ..............................................................2-3  
Registering destinations in Address Book............................................2-4  
Registering or editing a destination ..............................................2-4  
Alternative 1: Registering or editing directly into the address book....2-7  
Alternative 2: Registering or editing the fax number using the numeric keys...2-8  
Alternative 3: Registering an e-mail address using the QWERTY keypad....2-9  
Deleting a destination ..................................................................2-10  
Alternative: Deleting directly from the address book.................2-11  
How to dial using the address book.............................................2-12  
Call group dialing ................................................................................2-14  
Registering or editing a call group...............................................2-14  
Deleting a call group.....................................................................2-15  
How to dial using a call group......................................................2-16  
Making a phone call.............................................................................2-19  
How to dial using the address book.............................................2-19  
If the call fails ...............................................................................2-20  
How to receive a phone call..........................................................2-20  
Adjusting the optional handset volume.......................................2-20  
Adjusting the speaker volume......................................................2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The address book  
You can register up to 300 frequently used destinations into the address book.  
The destination name, fax number and e-mail address can be registered into the  
address book. You can also add these destinations into a group.  
In addition, you can simply search the destination name registered in the address  
book.  
NOTE:  
• For details on registering or deleting destinations in address book, see page  
2-4.  
• For details on address book dialing, see “How to dial using the address book”  
on page 2-12.  
• For details on call group dialing, see page 2-14.  
• For details on phone calling, see page 2-19.  
The address book display  
When you press the “All” tab in the address book display, all the registered destina-  
tions will be displayed. Press the “Fax” tab to show only the fax numbers that have  
been registered and the “e-mail” tab to show only the e-mail addresses that have  
been registered.  
The displayed soft keys change depending on the tab you select (The order of dis-  
played keys after pressing [Others] also changes, but the item description remain  
the same.)  
Search  
Press this to search  
a destination’s fax  
number or e-mail ad-  
dress. (See page 5-15.)  
Add/Edit  
Press this to register  
a destination into the  
address book or edit  
an existing destina-  
tion.  
Index  
Displays the destina-  
tions in alphabetical  
or group or numeric  
order. (See page 2-3.)  
Page change keys  
Press this to change  
the page view.  
Page number  
Destination  
Currently displayed  
page/total pages.  
This allows you to  
review to destinations  
you have selected/reg-  
istered. 5 destinations  
are displayed at a  
time.  
(When “All” tab is selected)  
Tabs  
The registered destinations are listed by the sending  
method. Press a tab to display the classified destinations.  
(When “Fax” tab is selected)  
(When “e-mail” tab is selected)  
2-2  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
[Index]  
• [Symbol]................. When you press this key, only the destination names starting  
with a symbol or number are displayed.  
• [Group]................... Lists the registered group names.  
• [ABC] to [WXYZ]... When you press one of these keys, only the destination names  
starting with the selected alpha characters will be displayed.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Special dialing characters  
7
You can enter special dialing characters when registering the address book. The  
chart below briefly describes each of these characters.  
8
Character  
Description  
Each pause lasts two seconds.  
If you must wait for another dial tone or signal at any point in the dial-  
ing sequence, enter a pause.  
9
/P  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(You can change the pause length. See page 12-6.)  
Makes long numbers easier to be read.  
Switches from pulse-dialing to tone-dialing.  
No need to use this character when using a tone line.  
/T  
Enters a “Dial prefix code” to access the alternative telephone network.  
“/N” must be entered before the first of number.  
/N  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-3  
Registering destinations in Address Book  
Registering or editing a destination  
Your machine can store up to 300 destinations in the Address Book. Each destina-  
tions are designated by a three-digit identifier code (001 through 300.)  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Address Book Entry].  
2
Press [Enter/Edit].  
3
Press the address book number you want to register or edit.  
4
When registering an empty destination, the QWERTY keypad will be shown  
and the destination name must be registered. To edit the destination name,  
press [Name] and edit the name.  
2-4  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Enter the destinations name.  
5
1
2
3
The name field must be registered.  
• Up to 30 characters can be entered.  
• For details on character entry, see page 1-10.  
4
5
(2) Press [Enter].  
(1) Press [Fax No.].  
6
6
(2) Use the numeric keys to enter the destinations fax number. (Up to 40 digits)  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
You must register either the fax number or e-mail address.  
• Pause and other dialing symbols can be also entered. (See “Special dialing  
characters” on page 2-3.)  
(3) Press [Enter].  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-5  
If you want to add this destination to a call group:  
(You can add either the fax number, e-mail address or both to a call group.)  
7
• Call groups must be registered in advance. (For details on registering call  
groups, see page 2-14.)  
• Up to 32 groups can be registered.  
(1) Press [Group].  
(2) Select the applicable group(s).  
(3) Press [Enter].  
If you want to enter the e-mail address:  
(1) Press [e-mail].  
8
(2) Enter the e-mail address.  
You must register either the fax number or e-mail address.  
• Up to 50 characters can be entered.  
• For details on character entry, see page 1-10.  
(3) Press [Enter].  
If you want to add this destination to a call group:  
9
• Call groups must be registered in advance. (For details on registering call  
groups, see page 2-14.)  
• Up to 32 groups can be registered.  
(1) Press [Group].  
(2) Select the applicable group(s).  
(3) Press [Enter].  
2-6  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
10  
1
2
3
The registration destinations will be displayed.  
11  
12  
4
To register another destination, repeat the procedure from step 4.  
Press [Reset] to exit the operation and return to the standby mode.  
5
NOTE: To print a list of address book entries, press [Setting], [List], [Address Book], then [Yes].  
6
7
Alternative 1: Registering or editing directly into the address book  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
8
1
Press [Add/Edit].  
2
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Following the operation from step 4 in “Registering or editing a destination”.  
3
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-7  
Alternative 2: Registering or editing the fax number using the numeric keys  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
Use the numeric keys to enter the destination’s fax number.  
2
Press [Register].  
3
Select the address book number you want to register using [ ] or [ ], then  
select [Yes].  
4
Unregistered number is displayed first. If you select an address book number  
that has already been registered, the fax number will be overwritten with the  
new number.  
Follow steps 5 to 12 on pages 2-5 to 2-7.  
5
2-8  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alternative 3: Registering an e-mail address using the QWERTY keypad  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
Press “e-mail” tab.  
2
Press [Mail Address].  
3
1
2
3
4
5
(When “e-mail” tab is selected)  
6
Use the QWERTY keypad to enter the destination’s e-mail address.  
4
5
Press [Register].  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select the address book number you want to register using [ ] [ ] or the  
numeric keys, then select [Yes].  
6
Unregistered number is displayed first. If you select an address book number  
that has already been registered, the e-mail address will be overwritten with  
the new address.  
Follow steps 5 to 12 on pages 2-5 to 2-7.  
7
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-9  
Deleting a destination  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Address Book Entry], then [Delete].  
2
3
4
Select the address book number you want to delete.  
Press [Yes] to delete.  
Press [No] to return to step 3 without deleting the number.  
To delete another destination, repeat steps 3 to 4.  
Otherwise, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
5
2-10 USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alternative: Deleting directly from the address book  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
Press [Add/Edit].  
2
Select the address book number you want to delete.  
3
1
2
3
4
5
6
Press [Delete].  
4
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Yes] to delete.  
5
Press [No] to return to step 4 without deleting the number.  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK 2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to dial using the address book  
Sending a fax or e-mail using the address book  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Adjust the document resolution and contrast, if necessary.  
3
(1) Select the tab that contains the destination you want to send to.  
4
(When “All” tab is selected)  
(2) Press [Page Up] or [Page Down] to display the specified destination.  
(3) Press the desired destination.  
Alternatives  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Adjust the document resolution and contrast, if necessary.  
3
Press [Others].  
4
Press [Address Book].  
5
NOTE: You can assign [Address Book] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
2-12 USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Use [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the address book number (001 to  
300).  
6
1
2
3
4
(2) Press [Enter].  
(1) Press [Fax] or [e-mail].  
5
7
You can select both [Fax] and [e-mail].  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(2) Press [Enter] twice.  
Press [Start].  
8
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK 2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Call group dialing  
If you frequently send the same fax/e-mail message to several destinations, use call  
group dialing. Call groups can store several destinations, so you can quickly broad-  
cast to multiple destinations by using this feature.  
Registering or editing a call group  
Your machine can store up to 32 call groups.  
Press [Setting], [Group].  
1
Press [Add].  
2
(1) Enter the group name.  
3
The group name must be registered.  
• Up to 24 characters can be entered.  
• For details on character entry, see page 1-10.  
(2) Press [Enter].  
2-14 USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Press [Group Members].  
4
(2) Specify the destination(s) to add to the group.  
• Specify the destination(s) using the address book.  
– or –  
• Specify the address book number.  
You cannot use the numeric keys to manually enter a destination. Group mem-  
bers must be pre-registered into the address book before they can be added to a  
group.  
NOTE:  
1
2
Fax numbers and e-mail addresses can be registered into the same call group.  
(3) Press [Enter].  
3
A group information will be displayed.  
5
6
4
To register additional call groups, press [Enter], then repeat the procedure from  
step 2.  
Press [Reset] to exit the operation and return to the standby mode.  
5
NOTE:  
• To print a list of call groups, press [Setting], [List], [Group]. Then press [Yes].  
• Destinations can be added to a group during the initial registration process.  
(See page 2-4.)  
6
7
8
Deleting a call group  
9
Press [Setting], [Group].  
1
2
3
Press the call group you want to delete.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Delete], [Yes].  
If you want to exit without deleting, press [No].  
To delete another call group, repeat the procedure from step 2.  
Otherwise, press [Reset] to exit and return to the standby mode.  
4
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK 2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to dial using a call group  
Sending a fax or e-mail using a call group  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Adjust the document resolution and contrast, if necessary.  
3
Press [Others], [Group Tx].  
4
NOTE: You can assign [Group Tx] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
(1) Press the group(s) you want to send to.  
5
(2) Press [Enter] twice.  
• If you want to edit the selected destination, press [Location] and edit it.  
Press [Start].  
6
• If you want to cancel the a transmission that is in progress, use the Review  
Commands feature. See “Chapter 6 Reviewing or canceling commands”.  
2-16 USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alternative:  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Press [Index].  
2
3
1
2
3
4
5
Press [Group].  
4
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select the call group for group transmission.  
5
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK 2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When you press [Non Group Members], destinations not included in a call  
group will be displayed.  
NOTE:  
Press the destination you want to add to the group, and press [Enter].  
Press [Start].  
7
• If you want to cancel the a transmission that is in progress, use the Review  
Commands feature. See “Chapter 6 Reviewing or canceling commands” on  
page 6-1.  
2-18 USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Making a phone call  
Besides entering the destination directly, you can simply search the destination  
name registered in the address book to make a phone call. There are various  
searching methods, such as alpha, group or numeric.  
How to dial using the address book  
1
When using [Monitor], press [FAX] to display to the Fax standby mode.  
NOTE:  
Connect the optional handset or an external phone to your machine to make a  
phone call.  
2
3
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Lift the handset. Or press “Fax” tab, [Monitor].  
Specify the destination.  
1
2
3
4
A. Numeric keys  
Press the numeric keys to enter the destination number.  
5
B. Address Book-1  
6
(1) Press [Address Book].  
(2) Use the numeric keys or [ ] [ ] to enter the address book number.  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(3) Press [Enter].  
C. Address Book-2  
Specify the destination using the address book.  
For details on how to use the address book, see page 2-12.  
NOTE:  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK 2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the call fails  
If the call fails, the next steps will depend on the type of call it was (fax or phone).  
If it was a fax call…  
Your machine will automatically redial the number. It will keep trying until one  
of the following occurs:  
• It successfully reaches the other number.  
• The maximum redial attempts has been reached.  
If it was a regular phone call…  
You will have to redial manually:  
Lift the handset.  
1
Press [Redial].  
2
Your machine can remember the last 10 dialed numbers.  
Select the number you want to call.  
3
Press [Start].  
4
How to receive a phone call  
Lift the handset when the machine rings.  
1
You can receive a call with the machine’s handset even if the power has been  
turned OFF.  
NOTE:  
Answer the phone.  
2
Adjusting the optional handset volume  
The small switches on the side of your machine’s handset adjusts the ringer and  
receiver volume.  
• Ringer Volume Control.......Adjust the ringer volume to one of three settings  
: High, Medium or Low.  
• Receiver Volume Control....If it is hard to hear the remote person’s voice, adjust  
the receiver volume to one of three settings  
: High, Medium, or Low.  
Ringer Volume  
Receiver Volume  
2-20 USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjusting the speaker volume  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
2
3
Press “Fax” tab.  
Press [Monitor].  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Press [Volume].  
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select the desired volume and press [Enter].  
Press [Monitor] to hang up.  
USING THE ADDRESS BOOK 2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2-22 USING THE ADDRESS BOOK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
3
Faxing  
Before sending........................................................................................3-2  
Document handling ........................................................................3-2  
Scanning resolution........................................................................3-2  
Scanning contrast ...........................................................................3-3  
Sending method ..............................................................................3-3  
Memory overflow message..............................................................3-4  
Sending a fax..........................................................................................3-5  
Memory transmission.....................................................................3-5  
Real-time transmission (non-memory transmission) ...................3-8  
Manual transmission (non-memory transmission).......................3-9  
Changing Document Scan in Mid Scan (Mixed Transmission)..3-10  
Redialing...............................................................................................3-13  
Automatic fax redialing................................................................3-13  
Manual redialing ..........................................................................3-13  
Receiving a fax .....................................................................................3-15  
Selecting the reception mode .......................................................3-15  
Manual reception mode ................................................................3-15  
Automatic reception mode............................................................3-16  
Answering calls manually............................................................3-17  
If paper runs out during fax reception ........................................3-17  
Settings for fax reception.....................................................................3-20  
Setting the number of rings .........................................................3-20  
Print settings ................................................................................3-20  
Advanced fax functions........................................................................3-23  
Broadcasting .................................................................................3-24  
Fax & Copy....................................................................................3-28  
Sending faxes with TTI information attached ............................3-30  
Cover page.....................................................................................3-32  
Delayed transmission ...................................................................3-34  
Batch transmission.......................................................................3-35  
Specifying the document scanning size .......................................3-41  
Polling transmission.....................................................................3-42  
Overseas transmission .................................................................3-43  
Using an alternative telephone network service provider (Dial prefix)....3-44  
Block junk fax ...............................................................................3-46  
Polling reception ...........................................................................3-50  
Fax forwarding..............................................................................3-51  
Separator page..............................................................................3-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before sending  
Document handling  
Before you begin please review the acceptable document sizes and proper setting  
methods on pages 1-24 to 1-25.  
Scanning resolution  
Normal is suitable for most text documents and simple drawings.  
Fine is ideal for maps, moderately complicated drawings, floorplans or handwrit-  
ten documents.  
Superfine (“S-Fine” on the display) reproduces the detail of extremely compli-  
cated drawings or line art.  
Photo (“Photo” on the display) captures shades in photos and drawings.  
To change the scanning resolution:  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
Press [Resolution].  
2
Select one of the resolution types.  
3
Press [Enter].  
4
You can change the default setting for [Resolution]. See “Accessing the default  
settings” on page 12-4.  
NOTE:  
3-2  
FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scanning contrast  
Setting the scanning contrast allows you to compensate for any excessive lightness  
or darkness, as the case may be, of the document pages you are sending.  
To change the scanning contrast:  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
1
Press [Contrast].  
2
Select one of the contrast types.  
3
2
3
4
5
6
7
Normal  
Darker  
Lighter  
Lighest  
Darkest  
8
Press [Enter].  
4
9
You can change the default setting for [Contrast]. See “Accessing the default  
settings” on page 12-4.  
NOTE:  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Sending method  
The following four sending methods are available on your machine.  
Memory transmission:  
For a normal memory transmission, your machine: (1) scans the entire document  
into memory, (2) dials the other fax machine, and (3) transmits the document.  
Quick memory transmission:  
For a quick memory transmission, your machine doesn’t wait to scan all pages into  
memory before dialing. After it scans the first page of your document, your machine  
will dial the other fax machine. When it makes contact, your machine transmits  
the stored document from memory while at the same time scanning the remaining  
pages of your document into memory.  
The quick memory transmission is defaulted to [ON]. However, you can turn the  
defaut to [OFF]. (See “Fax settings” on page 12-4.)  
FAXING  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Real-time transmission:  
In the following cases, the machine doesn’t use memory for fax sending.  
• When memory transmission is turned off.  
• When the machine’s memory is full  
In Real time transmission, the next page will not scan until the current page has  
been transmitted.  
Notes for real time transmissions:  
• The document glass cannot be used for real time transmission.  
You can dial only one destination.  
Manual transmission:  
Use manual transmission when the other fax machine uses manual reception or  
when you transmit after finishing a phone conversation.  
Notes for manual transmissions:  
You can dial only one destination.  
Memory overflow message  
In normal memory transmission, if you have stored too much information in your  
machine’s memory, a Memory overflow.” message will appear on the display:  
This appears because (1) too many pages have been stored in the memory, or (2)  
the pages that are stored have too much information on them for your machine to  
remember.  
If this message appears, press [Yes] to tell your machine to keep as many pages  
in memory as possible, or press [No] to delete all pages stored during the current  
operation (but not previous operations).  
Dividing a large document into smaller batches will help you avoid this error.  
Use real time transmissions to avoid these problems. (See “Real-time transmission”,  
page 3-8.)  
NOTE: If the machine is idle for 3 minutes, the machine will automatically delete any  
document stored in memory during the last operation.  
You can change the reset time. For details, see “Accessing the management set-  
tings” on page 12-11.  
3-4  
FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a fax  
Memory transmission  
Sending a fax using the ADF  
1
Set the document in the ADF. (See page 1-25 for details.)  
1
2
3
4
5
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2.)  
Set the various functions, if necessary.  
2
3
Specify the destination.  
4
5
6
7
8
9
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
– or –  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
– or –  
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See page  
3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
Press [Reset] to cancel the settings.  
Press [Start].  
6
(If you specify the destination using the address book, no need to press [Start].)  
NOTE: • If you want to cancel a transmission while the document is scanning, press  
[Stop].  
If you want to cancel a transmission that is in progress, use the Review Com-  
mands feature. See “Chapter 6 Reviewing or canceling commands” on page  
6-1.  
• Transmission reservation can be performed while communicating. The  
reserved transmission will start when the current communication is com-  
pleted. Transmission can be reserved for up to 100 communications.  
• If the call fails, see “Redialing” on page 3-13.  
FAXING  
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a fax using the document glass  
Set the document on the document glass. (See page 1-25 for details.)  
1
2
3
4
5
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2.)  
Set the various functions, if necessary.  
Specify the destination.  
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
– or –  
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See page  
3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
Press [Reset] to cancel the settings.  
Press [Start].  
6
(If you specify the destination using the address book, no need to press [Start].)  
• Pressing [No] during document scanning will start the fax transmission of all  
documents when the scan has been completed.  
When scanning has been completed, set the next document.  
7
3-6  
FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Next Doc]. The scanning of the next document will begin.  
8
1
2
3
• Press [Tx Start] when all the documents have been scanned.  
Fax transmission will start.  
4
9
5
NOTE: • If you want to cancel a transmission while the document is scanning, press  
[Stop].  
6
If you want to cancel a transmission that is in progress, use the Review Com-  
mands feature. See “Chapter 6 Reviewing or canceling commands” on page  
6-1.  
7
• Transmission reservation can be performed while communicating. The  
reserved transmission will start when the current communication is com-  
pleted. Transmission can be reserved for up to 100 communications.  
8
• If the call fails, see “Redialing” on page 3-13.  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
FAXING  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Real-time transmission (non-memory transmission)  
Your machine will dial the remote fax machine and once contact is made, scanning  
and transmitting will proceed in real-time.  
• With real time transmission, you can watch each page as it is scanned and sent.  
To perform a real time transmission:  
Set the document in the ADF.  
1
The document glass cannot be used for real time transmission.  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
NOTE:  
2
3
4
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2.)  
Press [Others], [Prev] or [Next], [Memory Tx], then press [Enter].  
(When “All” tab is selected)  
Now the memory transmission is set to [OFF].  
NOTE: You can assign [Memory Tx] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
You can change the default setting for [Memory Tx]. See “Accessing the  
default settings” on page 12-4.  
Specify the destination.  
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
5
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
Press [Reset] to cancel the settings.  
With real time transmission, you can dial only one destination. When you select  
multiple destinations, real time transmission will be disabled.  
NOTE:  
Press [Start].  
6
• To cancel the transmission, use Review commands features, see “Chapter 6  
Reviewing or canceling commands”.  
3-8  
FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manual transmission (non-memory transmission)  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Press “Fax” tab.  
3
1
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2.)  
4
2
Press [Monitor].  
5
– or –  
3
Lift the handset if you have connected an optional handset or an external tele-  
phone to your machine.  
4
In either case, the following display will appear:  
5
6
7
8
9
Specify the destination.  
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
6
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
Press [Monitor] on hang up the handset to cancel the settings.  
You can dial only one destination for manual transmission.  
NOTE:  
When you hear fax tones from the remote fax machine, press [Start].  
7
If a person answers the phone, use the handset to tell that person that you are  
trying to send a fax. When you hear fax tones, press [Start].  
If the call fails when you use [Monitor] to dial, press [Monitor] to hang up.  
If you are using the handset, hang up after pressing [Start].  
•To cancel the transmission, use the Review Commands feature. (See “Chapter  
6 Reviewing or canceling commands”)  
FAXING  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing Document Scan in Mid Scan (Mixed Transmission)  
The document glass or the ADF can scan the document. Both scanning devices can  
be used in combination, such as for a cover page and map, and transmitted at the  
same time.  
Basics for scanning the next document  
NOTE:  
• To scan the next document, set the Next Doc setting to [Yes] while scanning  
the current document.  
• The ADF’s default setting for Next Doc is [No]. To have the next document  
scanned, press [Yes] while scanning the current document.  
• For the document glass, the default setting for Next Doc is set to [Yes].  
• If you set Next Doc to [No] during scanning, the transmission will begin after  
scanning is completed.  
ADF  
Document glass  
Set the document in the ADF.  
1
2
(1) Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
(2) Specify the destination.  
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12)  
– or –  
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See page  
3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
Press [Reset] to cancel the settings.  
3-10 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Start].  
3
1
2
3
Press [Yes] while scanning the document.  
4
4
5
6
7
8
9
When scanning is completed, set the next document on the document glass.  
Press [Next Doc]. The next document will be scanned.  
5
6
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Tx Start] when all the documents have been scanned.  
7
Transmission will begin.  
• Press [Stop] to cancel the scan.  
• Transmission will also begin when [Start] is pressed.  
FAXING 3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Document glass  
ADF  
Set the document on the document glass.  
1
2
(1) Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
(2) Specify the destination.  
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12)  
– or –  
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See page  
3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
Press [Reset] to cancel the settings.  
Press [Start].  
3
When scanning is completed, set the next document in the ADF.  
Press [Next Doc]. Document scanning will begin.  
4
5
Transmission will start when scanning has been completed.  
• Press [Stop] to cancel the scan.  
6
3-12 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Redialing  
Automatic fax redialing  
If the transmission failed because the line was busy, “Auto Redial” will be displayed  
and the machine will automatically redial the number up to twice in one minute  
intervals .  
(You can change this setting, see “Fax setting” on page 12-4.)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
If the last redial attempt fails, the following message will be displayed and also the  
error message will automatically print. Check the message and transmit again.  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
If you want to end the redial procedures, delete the redial command of it from  
the command list. (See “Chapter 6 Reviewing or canceling commands”.)  
NOTE:  
Manual redialing  
The last 10 numbers for fax transmissions/phone calls are kept in memory.  
Set the document.  
1
2
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
FAXING 3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Redial].  
3
(When “All” tab is selected)  
Select the fax number you want to redial.  
4
The selected fax number will be displayed.  
5
You can edit the number, if necessary.  
Press [Enter].  
6
7
Press [Start].  
You can register the destination in the Address Book from the display in step 5.  
NOTE:  
1 Press [Register].  
2 Following the steps from step 4 in “Alternative 2: Registering or editing the  
fax number using the numeric keys”. For details, see page 2-8.  
3-14 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Receiving a fax  
Selecting the reception mode  
Press [Setting], [User Install], [Reception Mode].  
1
2
Select your desired reception mode.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Your machine has five different reception modes:  
• Fax Ready Mode (see “Automatic reception mode” on next page)  
• Tel/Fax Ready Mode (see “Automatic reception mode” on next page)  
• Fax/Tel Ready Mode (see “Automatic reception mode” on next page)  
• Ans/Fax Ready Mode (see “Automatic reception mode” on next page)  
• Tel Ready Mode (see “Manual reception mode” below)  
7
8
9
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
4
Press [Reset] to exit.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Manual reception mode  
Tel Ready Mode  
Use it if:  
You want to use the same line for both fax and phone calls.  
You mainly receive phone calls.  
In this mode:  
Your machine never answers the calls automatically. You must answer each call  
as described in “Answering calls manually” (page 3-17).  
You will need:  
• An optional handset or an external phone connection.  
FAXING 3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic reception mode  
Fax Ready Mode  
Use it if:  
Your machine uses its own phone line and doesn’t share it with a phone or an  
answering machine.  
In this mode:  
Your machine answers each call and attempts to receive a fax.  
Tel/Fax Ready Mode  
Use it if:  
You want to use the same line for both fax and phone calls.  
You are using the machine as both a fax machine and a telephone but its  
primary use will be as a telephone.  
In this mode:  
Your machine will ring the set number of times (the default setting is twice). If  
you don’t answer the call while ringing, your machine will answer the call auto-  
matically. If a caller sends a fax, your machine will begin to receive it. If a voice  
call comes in, your machine will alert you with a special ring prompting you to  
pick up the handset. (The telephone connected to your machine will not ring.)  
You will need:  
• An optional handset or an external phone connection.  
Fax/Tel Ready Mode  
Use it if:  
You want to use the same line for both fax and phone calls.  
You are using the machine as both a fax machine and a telephone, but its  
primary use will be for faxing.  
In this mode:  
Your machine receives faxes silently but also alerts you when a regular voice call  
comes in. (Your machine will beep once at the end of each reception.)  
When a voice call comes in, your machine will alert you with a special ring (The  
telephone connected to your machine will not ring). If you hear the machine  
ringing, pick up the handset.  
You will need:  
• An optional handset or an external phone connection.  
Ans/Fax Ready Mode  
Use it if:  
You are connecting an answering machine to your machine.  
In this mode:  
An answering machine connected to your machine will answer each call.  
If a voice call comes in, the answering machine will record the incoming mes-  
sage.  
If your machine hears a fax tone, it will begin receiving the fax message.  
You will need:  
• An optional handset or an external phone connection.  
3-16 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using an answering machine with your machine:  
Set the machine to Ans/Fax Ready Mode (See “Selecting the reception mode” on  
page 3-15.).  
1
Set your answering machine to answer calls after no more than two rings.  
2
Create a new outgoing message on your answering machine.  
Your answering machine’s outgoing message should be no longer than 10 sec-  
onds.  
3
1
2
Answering calls manually  
3
NOTE: • To answer a call manually, you must install an optional handset or an exter-  
nal phone to your machine.  
4
• Make sure there are no documents in the ADF.  
5
Receiving a call manually with an optional handset or an external phone  
6
In “Tel Ready Mode ” or “Tel/Fax Ready Mode”, when the optional handset or exter-  
nal phone rings, pick up the handset:  
• When you hear the fax tones (“beep-beep-beep”), pick up the handset and  
press [Start]. After pressing [Start], put down the optional handset or the  
external phone’s handset. Press [Start] as soon as you hear the beeping  
sound, this will prompt the remote machine to begin transmitting.  
7
8
9
If paper runs out during fax reception  
When your machine runs out of paper, it will beep, the Alarm lamp will light and  
the machine will show which paper source is empty — the 1st cassette, 2nd cassette  
(optional) or the bypass tray.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(When paper runs out in the 1st cassette)  
FAXING 3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Out-of-paper reception  
If your machine runs out of paper, it can store up to 250 fax receptions in its  
memory. This is called “out-of-paper reception.” Once you refill the paper supply, the  
machine will automatically print the messages stored in memory.  
NOTE: The number of pages (not receptions) your fax machine can store for out-of-  
paper reception will vary. It depends on:  
Your machine’s memory capacity  
• Types of documents sent to your machine  
• Fax resolution of the documents sent to your machine  
Checking the out-of-paper reception copy print queue  
The out-of-paper reception print queue status can be checked.  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Management].  
2
(1) Press [Next].  
3
(2) Press [Display Jobs in Queue].  
Press [FaxReceive Document].  
4
3-18 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This displays the intercepted reception print queue status.  
5
1
2
3
NOTE: Documents stored in memory will automatically print when printing becomes  
4
available.  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
FAXING 3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings for fax reception  
Setting the number of rings  
Default setting: Twice  
You can set how many times your machine will ring before answering a call. Choose  
from 2 to 15 rings.  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Other Settings], [Redial Attempts].  
1
Use [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the number of rings.  
2
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
3
Press [Reset] to exit and return to the standby mode.  
4
Print settings  
You can set three parameters for printing received fax documents:  
• Rx reduction rate  
• Reduction margin  
• Paper save function  
All three can be set in the same procedure, mentioned on next page.  
Each description is as follows:  
Reception reduction rate:  
Reception reduction lets you set the machine to reduce large incoming documents  
to a size that fits the paper in your machine. (This setting doesn’t affect your  
machine’s copying capabilities.)  
Below are the options for the print reduction rate for fax reception:  
Setting  
Auto  
Description  
Automatically reduces printouts at variable rates down to a mini-  
mum of 50%. Tries to reduce printouts to fit on one sheet of the  
selected paper size. If it cannot reduce the document to fit on one  
page, the image will print at 100% size on two or more pages.  
100%  
Does not reduce documents. (Due to the sender’s TTI, this may  
print two pages when receiving a one-page fax document.)  
Reduction margin:  
Your machine’s reduction margin is measured in inches (in). We will define reduc-  
tion margin by explaining how it is used:  
When a fax message enters your machine’s memory, the machine measures the  
message length and compares it to (a) the length of your selected paper (not includ-  
ing the print margins) plus (b) the reduction margin you set. If the length of the  
incoming message is shorter than (a) plus (b), your machine will print the message  
on one sheet.  
If it is longer, your machine will print the message on two or more sheets.  
An Auto reduction setting and a reduction margin setting of 1.5 in. will print most  
incoming faxes as single pages. Try this combination first and if it does not work  
select a different setting.  
3-20 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper save function:  
Half-page reception  
Half-page reception can conserve paper if some of the faxes you receive are half-  
page, “Memo-sized” messages. When activated, this feature tells the machine to  
combine two of these half-page receptions onto a single sheet.  
Half-page reception only combines half-page messages sent back-to-back during the  
same transmission. It won’t combine two half-page faxes from separate transmis-  
sions.  
1
2
Duplex reception*  
Duplex reception can save paper by duplexing received faxes.  
When activated, this feature tells the machine to combine and print inbound docu-  
ments two-up.  
3
*The duplex printing unit is required.  
4
To adjust the print settings  
5
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Other Settings], [Next].  
1
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
When you set the reception reduction rate  
Default setting: Auto  
Press [Rx Reduction Rate].  
2
Select the reduction rate.  
3
Press [Enter].  
4
FAXING 3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When you set the reduction margin  
Default setting: 1.5 in.  
Press [Reduction Margin].  
2
Use [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the reduction margin.  
3
Press [Enter].  
4
When you set the paper save function  
Default setting: OFF  
Press [Paper Saving].  
2
Select the paper save function.  
3
*The duplex printing unit is required to use the [Duplex Rx] function.  
Press [Enter].  
4
5
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
3-22 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced fax functions  
The table below lists the advanced functions that can be used in the Fax mode.  
To select the advanced fax functions:  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
1
Press [Others].  
2
Press [Prev] or [Next] and select the desired function.  
3
2
See the pages indicated for detailed information.  
3
You can assign a function that you frequently use to a soft key for instant  
recall. (See page 10-2.)  
NOTE:  
4
Advanced function Descriptions  
Reference  
p. 3-24  
p. 3-13  
p. 2-19  
p. 2-1  
Broadcast  
Redial  
Use this to send a fax to multiple destinations.  
5
Specify the destination to resend a fax.  
Obtains a dial tone for on-hook dialing.  
6
Monitor  
Address Book  
Use this when specifying the destination by  
address book number.  
7
Fax Forward  
Fax&Copy  
Group Tx  
Security Rx  
TTI  
Enable or disable fax forwarding.  
Enable or disable Fax&Copy.  
p. 3-51  
p. 3-28  
8
Select the group to make a group transmission. p. 2-14  
9
Enable or disable secure reception.  
Enable or disable TTI sending.  
Select the TTI to use.  
p. 11-3  
p. 3-31  
p. 3-30  
p. 3-32  
p. 13-8  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
TTI Select  
Cover Page  
Tx Report  
Select whether or not to attach a cover page.  
Prints the transmit confirmation report for the  
next transmission.  
Delayed Tx  
Batch Tx  
Use this to make a delayed transmission.  
Stores a document for batch transmission.  
Specify the scanning size for documents.  
Use this for polling reception.  
p. 3-34  
p. 3-35  
p. 3-41  
p. 3-50  
p. 10-38  
p. 10-37  
p. 3-43  
p. 3-5  
Scan Size  
Polling  
F-Code Polling  
F-Code Tx  
Overseas Tx  
Memory Tx  
Dialing Options  
Use this for F-code polling.  
Use this to make an F-code transmission.  
Enable or disable overseas transmission.  
Enable or disable memory transmission.  
Use this to enter the “/N” symbol.  
p. 2-3  
FAXING 3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Broadcasting  
The fastest way to fax one document to many destinations is to broadcast it.  
In an ordinary broadcast, you can send faxes and e-mails as you normally would,  
except you just add more fax numbers and e-mail addresses.  
You can enter up to 330 numbers:  
• Address book numbers: Up to 300 destinations  
• Manually-dialed numbers: Up to 30 destinations  
You can broadcast using any function that requires a fax number and e-  
mail address to be registered.  
To perform a broadcast transmission:  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2)  
3
Press [Broadcast].  
4
3-24 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specify the destination.  
5
1
2
3
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
– or –  
4
• Enter the e-mail address manually. (See page 4-2.)  
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
– or –  
• Use the call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
5
6
7
Press [Location] to review or delete the selected destinations. For details, see  
“Reviewing or deleting selected destinations” on next page.  
NOTE:  
8
Press [Start].  
6
9
NOTE: • To cancel the broadcast transmission, press [Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.]. (For  
details of fax canceling, see “Chapter 6 Reviewing or canceling commands”.)  
• If you frequently broadcast documents to the same destinations, use the call  
group dialing for added convenience. (See page 2-14.)  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
FAXING 3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reviewing or deleting selected destinations  
Before pressing [Start], you can review the broadcast destinations or delete a speci-  
fied destination(s).  
Location display  
[Location] is displayed when you send fax or e-mail using the following methods.  
• Broadcast transmissions  
• After entering fax numbers manually  
• After entering e-mail addresses manually  
• After selecting an address book number  
Help  
Delete  
Displays the descrip-  
Press this key after se-  
lecting the destination to  
delete.  
tion of keys in the  
Location display.  
Sort  
When you press this  
key after selecting  
the sending method:  
[To], [Cc] and [Bcc] for  
e-mail address, it sorts  
in the order of [To],  
[Cc], [Bcc].  
Specified destinations  
This displays the selected destinations. The displayed order from the top is as fol-  
lows:  
Switching key for  
[To], [Cc], [Bcc]  
(1) manually entered e-mail address,  
(2) e-mail address ([To], [Cc], [Bcc]) specified by address book,  
(3) manually entered fax number,  
Press this key to  
switch the sending  
method from [To], [Cc],  
[Bcc], [To].  
(4 ) fax number specified by address book.  
3-26 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specify the destinations for the broadcast transmission, and press [Location].  
1
2
3
1
2
3
The selected destinations will be displayed.  
4
5
6
7
8
9
Follow the steps below to delete the selected destinations.  
You can also change the sending method: [To], [Cc] and [Bcc] for e-mail  
addresses. (See “Location display” on page 3-26.)  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(1) Select the destination you want to delete.  
You can select multiple destinations.  
(2) Press [Delete] to delete the selected destination.  
(3) Press [Enter].  
To start the transmission, press [Start].  
4
FAXING 3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax & Copy  
Documents can be faxed and copied simultaneously with just one scanning opera-  
tion. This function is useful for internal communications when copies need to be  
made after sending a fax.  
• If the copy protect is set to [ON], Fax&Copy cannot be used. (See page 11-22.)  
NOTE:  
• Resolution for Fax & Copy will be either Fine or S-Fine. (No other selections  
are available.)  
Set the document.  
1
2
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Press [Others], [Fax&Copy].  
3
You can assign [Fax&Copy] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
NOTE:  
Press [ON], and then [Enter].  
4
Fax&Copy is now set. Press [Enter] again.  
5
3-28 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specify the destination.  
6
1
2
3
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
– or –  
• Enter the e-mail address manually. (See page 4-2.)  
4
5
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
– or –  
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See  
page3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
6
7
If you specify the destination using the address book, proceed to step 8.  
If you specify it by another method, proceed to step 7.  
8
Press [Start].  
7
9
The Copy standby mode will be displayed.  
8
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
After the Copy standby mode displays, you cannot switch to the Fax standby  
mode (by pressing [FAX]).  
NOTE:  
Perform copy setting adjustments as needed.  
• Press [Stop] to cancel Fax&Copy.  
9
Press [Start].  
10  
FAXING 3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending faxes with TTI information attached  
The default setting is “TTI 1”.  
Every fax and Internet fax page you send arrives at the receiving machine with a  
single line of text at the top of the page. This text lists your name, fax number, date  
& time of transmission and page number as shown below.  
You can select the name  
either TTI 1, TTI 2 or TTI 3  
Date and time  
of transmission Page number  
Your fax number  
Your name  
Fax: +1-123-456-7890  
MAY 5 2005 02:15pm P 001/001  
TTI information  
THE SLEREXE COMPANY LIMITED  
SAPORS LANE - BOOLE - DORSET - BH25 8ER  
TELEPHONE BOOLE (94513) 51617 - TELEX 123456  
You can select the three types of TTI (your name) stored in the “Specifying the  
initial settings” (See pages 1-16 to 1-22) for each transmission. Also, you can tell the  
machine whether or not to send the TTI information (See page 3-31).  
IMPORTANT:In some countries you are required by law to indicate your name and fax num-  
ber on every fax you send.  
Selecting TTI  
Register the TTI in advance. For details on registering the TTI, see page 1-20.  
NOTE:  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Press [Others], [TTI Select].  
(1) Select the TTI.  
1
2
3
• “TTI 1: (your entered name)” — The machine will send TTI 1.  
• “TTI 2: (your entered name)” — The machine will send TTI 2.  
• “TTI 3: (your entered name)” — The machine will send TTI 3.  
(2) Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
NOTE: You can assign [TTI Select] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
3-30 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending faxes with TTI information attached  
Press [FAX] to display to the Fax standby mode.  
1
Press [Others].  
2
Press [TTI].  
3
• [ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [TTI].  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Set it to [ON] when you send a fax with TTI information.  
Set it to [OFF] when you send a fax without TTI information.  
7
You can assign [TTI] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
You can change the default setting for [TTI]. See “Accessing the default set-  
tings” on page 12-4.  
NOTE:  
8
9
Press [Enter].  
4
5
Specify the destination.  
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
– or –  
• Enter the e-mail address manually. (See page 4-2.)  
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
– or –  
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See  
page3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
If you specify the destination using the address book, the transmission will  
begin.  
If you specify it by another method, proceed to step 6.  
Press [Start].  
6
FAXING 3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cover page  
Your machine can store a cover page and send it prior to each outgoing fax and  
Internet fax.  
The default setting is OFF.  
**MESSAGE **  
[RECEIVER]*  
(Destination's name)  
(Destination's fax number)  
(Destination's e-mail address)  
[SENDER]  
(Your name)  
(Your fax number)  
(Your e-mail address)  
[MESSAGE]  
(Enter your message)  
* When you directly enter the destination’s fax number and/or e-mail address, only  
the fax number or e-mail address will be printed. When you specify the destina-  
tion from the address book, the name, fax number and e-mail address registered  
in the address book will be printed.  
Turning the cover page on  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
2
3
Press [Others].  
Press [Cover Page].  
• [ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [Cover Page].  
Press [Enter].  
4
Now the cover page feature is working but your message line is blank. To enter  
a message, see “Entering the cover page message” on the next page.  
The usual TTI and the fax number you have entered in the Initial settings  
(page 1-16 to 1-22) and the e-mail address assigned to your machine will be  
pre-populated in the cover page automatically.  
NOTE: • For details on assigning an e-mail address to your machine, see the “Network  
Guide” contained in this product.  
You can assign [Cover Page] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
You can change the default setting for [Cover Page]. See “Accessing the default  
settings” on page 12-4.  
3-32 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering the cover page message  
Up to 120 characters can be entered for the message.  
When you enter over 60 characters, the line will be automatically broken to the  
next line. You can also insert up to 2 additional line breaks. 1 line break is counted  
as 2 characters. That means the number of characters you can enter will be up to  
116 when you insert 2 line breaks.  
Press [Setting].  
1
1
Press [Fax Settings].  
2
Press [Cover Page].  
2
3
3
4
5
6
7
Enter the cover page message.  
4
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
You can check the entered text by pressing [ViewText]. You cannot edit the text  
in this display. To return to the text editing display, press [Enter].  
NOTE:  
After you entered the cover page message, press [Enter].  
5
Printing the cover page  
To confirm that the cover page is set correctly, print a sample cover page from your  
machine. Press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Cover Page], then [Yes].  
FAXING 3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Delayed transmission  
Setting up a delayed transmission  
Your machine can store up to 100 delayed commands, each of which you can pro-  
gram up to 31 days in advance.  
Your machine only remembers the day of the month that it is supposed to send a  
delayed transmission. It does not remember the month itself. So if you want to send a  
transmission at 2:15 pm on 5 May, do not program the transmission sooner than 2:16  
pm on 5 April.  
If a real time transmission is specified, the document will remain set until the  
specified time, so you will not be able to send any other faxes.  
NOTE:  
To set up a delayed transmission:  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Press [Others], [Delayed Tx].  
3
You can assign [Delayed Tx] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
Enter the sending day and time.  
NOTE:  
4
• Use [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the sending day and  
time.  
Press [Enter] twice.  
5
6
Specify the destination.  
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
– or –  
• Enter the e-mail address manually. (See page 4-2.)  
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
– or –  
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See page  
3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
Press [Start].  
7
• To change the sending time after it has been set, you need to cancel the  
delayed transmission command and start over.  
NOTE:  
• To cancel the delayed command, press [Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.]. (For details  
of fax canceling, see “Chapter 6 Reviewing or canceling commands”.)  
3-34 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Batch transmission  
Batch transmission allows you to store multiple documents in an electronic “basket”  
throughout the day and then fax that entire basket to one destination.  
To do this, just tell the machine when and where the transmission should go. When  
that date and time arrives, your machine will transmit each document in the batch  
box to the remote fax machine. You can store up to 40 documents (each document  
can include one or more pages) into your machine’s five electronic batch boxes.  
1
Registering a batch box  
2
Before sending a batch transmission, you have to register batch boxes in your  
machine.  
3
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Fax Settings], [Batch Tx Box], [Enter/Edit].  
2
4
Select the batch transmission box you want to register.  
3
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Specify the destination using the numeric keys or the address book. Then press  
4
[Enter].  
• Only one destination can be set for each box.  
• Press [Location] to review or delete a destination that has been specified. (See  
page 3-26)  
NOTE:  
Press [Tx Time].  
5
FAXING 3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the sending day and time.  
6
NOTE: • Use [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ]or the numeric keys to enter the sending time.  
• Add “0” in front of one-digit numbers. (E.g.: 9 09)  
• Enter “00” for the day to send the stored documents at the same time every  
day.  
Press [Enter].  
7
8
Enter the batch box name.  
(1) Press [Box Name].  
• Up to 24 characters can be entered.  
NOTE:  
• For details on character entry, see page 1-10.  
(2) Enter the box name.  
(3) After you entered the name, press [Enter].  
3-36 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A list of the entered information is displayed.  
9
To register another batch transmission box, press [Enter], then repeat from  
step 3.  
10  
NOTE: The contents (settings) for batch transmission boxes that contain any docu-  
ments cannot be changed.  
1
To edit the settings of a batch transmission box you have regis-  
tered....  
Select the box you want to edit, and then edit the contents by overwriting or delet-  
ing the existing information in each step.  
2
3
NOTE: To print a list of batch boxes, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Batch Tx  
Box], then [Yes]. (See page 13-3.)  
4
Storing a document for batch transmission  
5
Your machine can store up to 40 documents (each document can include one page  
or many pages). Once the batch documents are transmitted, they are automatically  
erased from the batch box.  
6
NOTE: During transmission, a batch number for each document in the specified batch  
transmission box will be displayed. We recommend you should make a record  
of these batch numbers, which will control the documents and are required for  
reviewing and deleting documents.  
7
8
To store a document in a batch box for batch transmission:  
9
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Others].  
3
Press [Batch Tx].  
4
NOTE: You can assign [Batch Tx] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
Select the batch transmission box.  
5
FAXING 3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Yes].  
6
NOTE: To print a list of the documents stored in batch boxes, press [Setting], [List],  
[Other Lists], [Batch Tx Doc.], then [Yes].  
Printing a document stored in a batch box  
Press [Setting], [Store Doc Settings], [Print].  
1
Press [Batch Tx Doc.].  
2
Select the batch transmission box in which the documents you want to print  
are stored.  
3
NOTE: Empty batch transmission boxes cannot be selected.  
Select the file number you want to print.  
4
3-38 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Yes] to print stored document.  
5
1
2
3
4
Deleting a document stored in a batch box  
Press [Setting], [Stored Doc Settings], [Delete].  
1
5
Press [Batch Tx Doc.].  
2
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select the batch transmission box that contains the documents you want to  
delete.  
3
NOTE: Empty batch transmission boxes cannot be selected.  
FAXING 3-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select the file number you want to delete.  
4
Press [Yes] to delete the stored document.  
5
Erasing an empty batch box  
Batch boxes must be empty in order to be erased. If a box has documents stored in  
it, you must delete those before proceeding. (See “Deleting a document stored in a  
batch box” on page 3-39.)  
To erase an empty batch box:  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Batch Tx Box], [Delete].  
1
Press the batch transmission box you want to delete.  
2
When the confirmation message appears, press [Yes] to delete.  
3
3-40 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifying the document scanning size  
If the document is longer than the set width, only the scanned area will be sent.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
1
Press [Others], [Scan Size].  
3
NOTE: You can assign [Scan Size] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
2
Select the scan size.  
4
3
4
5
6
7
8
Press [Enter] twice.  
5
9
Specify the destination.  
• Use the numeric keys to dial the number.  
6
– or –  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• Enter the e-mail address manually. (See page 4-2.)  
– or –  
• Specify the destination using the address book. (See page 2-12.)  
– or –  
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See page  
3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
If you specify the destination using the address book, the transmission will  
begin.  
If you specify it by another method, proceed to step 7.  
To clear this setting, press [Reset].  
Press [Start].  
7
FAXING 3-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polling transmission  
Polling transmission allows someone to retrieve a document stored in your machine’s  
memory. The stored document will be sent when the other party calls you.  
Storing a document for polling  
Set the document.  
1
2
3
Press [Setting], [Store Doc Settings].  
Press [Store].  
Press [Polling Doc.]  
4
Press [Yes].  
5
NOTE: Once the remote fax machine polls the document you stored, your machine will  
automatically erase the document from memory.  
3-42 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing a stored polling document  
To print a polling document without deleting it, press [Setting], [Store Doc Set-  
tings], [Print], [Polling Doc.], then [Yes].  
Deleting a stored polling document  
To delete a polling document from your machine’s memory.  
Press [Setting], [Store Doc Settings], [Delete], [Polling Doc.], then [Yes].  
If you want to quit the operation without deleting, press [No].  
1
1
2
Overseas transmission  
3
When transmitting overseas, the transmission reliability can be improved.  
This function is available only when sending faxes.  
4
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
5
Press [Others].  
2
Press [Prev] or [Next], then press [OverseasTx].  
• [ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [OverseasTx].  
3
6
You can assign [OverseasTx] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
You can change the default setting for [OverseasTx]. See “Accessing the  
default settings” on page 12-4.  
NOTE:  
7
8
Press [Enter].  
4
5
9
Enter the fax number, and send the fax.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
FAXING 3-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using an alternative telephone network service provider (Dial prefix)  
When you make a call, you may want to use an alternative telephone network  
service provider to take advantage of lower rates. You can store the access codes in  
the “Dial Prefix” key.  
The following information describes how to program the access number.  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Fax Settings].  
2
Press [Other Settings].  
3
(1) Press [Prev].  
4
(2) Press [PreFix].  
(1) Enter the dial prefix number using the numeric keys.  
5
You can enter numbers up to 40 digits including numbers, Pause and Tone.  
Note that Pause and Tone will be counted as 2 characters each.  
NOTE:  
• If you must wait for another dial tone at dialing, press [Pause] to insert a  
pause (/P) at the end of the access number.  
(2) Press [Enter].  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
6
3-44 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending faxes using the Dial prefix feature  
To dial using the numeric keys  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Press [Others].  
3
1
(1) Press [Prev] or [Next].  
4
2
(2) Press [Dialing Options].  
You can assign [Dialing Options] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
NOTE:  
3
(1) Press [PreFix], then enter the fax number using the numeric keys.  
5
4
5
6
7
8
9
(2) Press [Enter].  
Press [Start].  
6
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
FAXING 3-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Block junk fax  
Your machine’s Block Junk Fax feature lets you bar the gates against unauthorized  
incoming faxes (“Junk fax”). But before you block junk fax, first understand how  
this feature works, to determine if it is right for you.  
There are four possible settings for Block Junk Fax:  
Off — The feature is not activated.  
Mode1 Your machine checks whether the last four digits of any phone number  
in your address book match the last four digits of the remote fax’s phone number.  
If it does not find a match, your machine will disconnect the call.  
Mode2 — This mode rejects any call from a number whose last four digits match  
any number in the blocked numbers list. Your machine can hold up to 50 blocked  
numbers.  
Mode3 — This mode rejects numbers that are not in the address book and also  
rejects numbers that are in the blocked numbers list. This mode lets you keep a  
number on your address book for transmitting, while still blocking incoming calls  
by putting it on the blocked numbers list.  
But before you activate the Block Junk Fax feature, please consider:  
Not all fax machine owners enter their phone numbers on their machine. — With  
Block Junk Fax activated, your machine would reject faxes from these machines.  
Access codes can cause confusion. — If an address book entry ends with an extra code,  
such as long-distance codes, Block Junk Fax will block out calls from those faxes.  
To set the mode for block junk fax  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Other Settings].  
1
2
Press [Block Junk Fax].  
Press [Setting].  
3
3-46 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Select the mode.  
4
1
2
3
(2) Press [Enter].  
4
The procedure will end if you select [OFF] or [Mode 1].  
If you selected either [Mode 2] or [Mode 3], proceed to step 5.  
5
Press [Enter/Edit].  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select a box to edit.  
6
To change numbers already registered, select the box containing the number  
you want to edit.  
NOTE:  
FAXING 3-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Using the numeric keys, enter the last four digits of the fax number you  
want to block. You can enter the last eight-digit number to identify each fax  
number, but only the last four-digit number will be used for blocked number.  
For example, if you want to block a fax from someone with a number of 123-  
456-7890, you should enter 7, 8, 9, 0:  
7
(2) Press [Enter].  
To enter another number, repeat from step 6.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
8
Deleting a number from the blocked numbers list  
To delete a number from the list:  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Other Settings], [Block Junk Fax].  
1
2
Press [Delete].  
Select the number you want to delete.  
3
3-48 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Yes] to delete.  
4
1
2
3
Press [No] to return to step 3 without deleting the number.  
NOTE:  
4
The selected number will be deleted. To delete another number, repeat from step  
5
5
3.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
6
Printing a list of the blocked numbers  
To print a list of blocked numbers, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Block Junk  
Fax] then [Yes].  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
FAXING 3-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polling reception  
Polling allows someone to fax a document to you without having to make the call or  
pay for it. There are two kinds of polling:  
• Regular polling — Your machine retrieves a document from a remote fax  
machine.  
• F-Code polling — Your machine retrieves a document stored in a F-code boxes  
on the remote fax machine. To do this, you must be communicating with  
another F-code-compliant machine. For more information on F-code commu-  
nication, see “F-code box feature,” on page 10-21.  
NOTE: For polling to work, the remote machine must be set up to be polled.  
Regular polling  
To set up your machine for regular polling:  
Make sure the document is loaded in the remote fax machine.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Press [Others].  
3
Press [Polling].  
4
NOTE: You can assign [Polling] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
(1) Select [ON] to perform polling.  
5
(2) Press [Enter].  
Press [Enter] to return to the standby display.  
6
Specify the destination and press [Start].  
7
After pressing [Start], you can stop the communication using the Review Com-  
mands feature. (See page 6-1)  
NOTE:  
3-50 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax forwarding  
This feature tells the machine to forward the received document automatically to  
another destination. You can set the time period for the machine to perform this  
procedure.  
NOTE: • Fax forwarding is not compatible with polling documents.  
• Fax forwarding is not available with the “Tel Ready” reception mode.  
1
The fax forwarding settings are different depending on your network connection.  
• When your machine is connected to the network:  
2
The fax forwarding settings must be configured using a web browser. You can  
configure the detailed transfer rule. From the control panel on your machine,  
you can toggle [ON] or [OFF] for fax forwarding when the transfer rule has been  
configured.  
3
• When your machine is not connected to the network:  
4
You can set the simply fax forwarding rule from the control panel.  
The following are descriptions when the machine is not connected to the network.  
For details of configuring fax forwarding setting using a web browser, refer to the  
“Using a web browser” of the “Network Guide”.  
5
Turning fax forwarding ON or OFF  
6
NOTE: To turn [ON] fax forwarding, you must register at least one transfer rule.  
7
Select [ON] in the fax forwarding setting to switch the individual transfer rules to  
[ON]. Faxes will be forwarded according to the registered rules.  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Fax Forward], [Setting].  
8
1
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(When your machine is connected to the network)  
(1) Select [ON] to perform fax forwarding.  
2
(2) Press [Enter].  
FAXING 3-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax forwarding is now set.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
3
Alternative  
There is another useful method to turn fax forwarding [ON] and [OFF] . This set-  
ting links to the setting for “Turning fax forwarding ON or OFF”.  
To turn fax forwarding [ON], you must register at least one transfer rule.  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Press [Others].  
NOTE:  
1
2
3
Press [FaxForward] to set the fax forwarding to [ON].  
(When “All” tab is selected)  
You can assign [FaxForward] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
NOTE:  
Fax forwarding is now set.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
3-52 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering or editing a transfer rule  
You can create up to 5 transfer rules.  
NOTE: When your machine is connected to the network, you cannot register, edit or  
delete the transfer rules from the machines control panel. Use a web browser to  
register, edit or delete the transfer rules. For details on registering and editing  
the transfer rules using the Browser, see the “Network Guide”.  
1
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Fax Forward].  
1
2
Press [Enter/Edit].  
2
3
4
5
6
7
Select a number to register a forwarding rule.  
3
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• Press [01:] when registering for the first time.  
• To change a transfer rule already registered, select the number you want to edit.  
(1) Enter the forwarding destination.  
4
FAXING 3-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
You can specify using the numeric keys, the address book, the call group.  
NOTE:  
You can register multiple destinations. (up to 303 destinations: 300 address  
book numbers and 3 specified using the numeric keys)  
• Press [Location] to review or delete the specified destinations. (See page 3-26)  
(2) Press [Enter].  
Individual settings  
(1) Press [Individual].  
5
(2) Press [ON] to forward faxes using these transfer rules.  
(3) Press [Enter].  
The default setting is [ON]. However, even if [ON] is selected for the individual  
setting, faxes will not be forwarded until the overall fax forwarding is set to  
[ON].  
NOTE:  
3-54 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specified time  
Specify the time fax forwarding is to be performed. If no time is registered, faxes  
will always be forwarded.  
(1) Press [Time].  
6
(2) Use the numeric keys to enter the time and date. Use the 12-hour format to  
enter the time. Press [Week day] to insert the day of the week.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
(3) Press [Enter].  
• Press [Always] to delete the specified time.  
You can also register either the day or time.  
NOTE:  
7
8
Auto print  
Set Auto print to [ON] if you want to print the received document before fowarding  
it.  
9
(1) Press [Auto Print].  
7
(2) Select [ON] if you want to print the received document in addition to for-  
warding it.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(3) Press [Enter].  
After registering all the settings, press [Enter].  
8
9
To register another transfer rule, repeat from step 3.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
FAXING 3-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting a transfer rule  
NOTE: When your machine is connected to the network, you cannot register, edit or  
delete the transfer rule from the machines control panel. Use the Browser to  
register, edit or delete the transfer rules. For details on registering and editing  
the transfer rules using the Browser, see “Network Guide”.  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Fax Forward], [Delete].  
Select the transfer rule you want to delete.  
1
2
Press [Yes] to delete.  
3
To delete another transfer rule, repeat from step 2.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
NOTE: To print a list of transfer rules, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Fax For-  
ward], then [Yes]. (See page 13-3.)  
3-56 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Separator page  
The separator page function can separate each received document by inserting  
blank paper between received fax jobs. For example, if you use the colored paper for  
the separator page, it is easy to identify each individual fax job.  
Setting the Separator page  
1
Press [Setting], [Paper Settings], [Separate Rx Page].  
1
2
3
2
3
4
5
6
Press [Setting].  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select the mode.  
To set the separator page ON, select [ON] and proceed to step 4.  
To set it OFF, select [OFF] and skip to step 7.  
FAXING 3-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Enter].  
4
5
(1) Press [Separator Cassette].  
NOTE: Paper sources will only appear on the control panel if they have been installed.  
(2) Select the separator page paper source.  
(3) Press [Enter].  
(1) Press [Prt On Separator Pg].  
6
(2) Determine if the separator page will have the first page printed on it or  
whether it should be left blank.  
If you want the seperator page to be left blank, select [OFF].  
If you want to print the first page of the received document on the separator  
page, select [ON].  
Separator page separates each received document.  
2
2
1
1
Blank  
2
1
2
1
Print on the separator page: [OFF]  
Print on the separator page: [ON]  
Press [Enter] to save the settings.  
7
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
3-58 FAXING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
4
Internet Fax functions  
Before sending........................................................................................4-2  
Sending an e-mail ..................................................................................4-2  
Entering an e-mail address using the QWERTY keypad.............4-2  
Re-mail ............................................................................................4-3  
Mail History ....................................................................................4-4  
Reviewing or canceling commands .......................................................4-6  
Advanced mail functions .......................................................................4-6  
Adding a text message to your e-mail............................................4-7  
Batch scanning..............................................................................4-11  
Checking for new e-mail...............................................................4-12  
Specifying the attachment file format .........................................4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before sending  
• For details on available document types and how to set documents, see “Docu-  
ment handling” on page 1-24 to 1-25.  
• For details on scanning resolution and contrast, see “Scaning resolution” on page  
3-2 and “Scanning contrast” on page 3-3.  
• For details on memory overflow messages, see “Memory overflow message” on  
page 3-4.  
Sending an e-mail  
• For details on the address book, see “The address book display” on page 2-2.  
• For details on registering or editing an e-mail address, see the following methods.  
• “Registering or editing a destination” on page 2-4.  
• “Alternative 1: Registering or editing directory into the address book” on page  
2-7.  
• “Entering an e-mail address using the QWERTY keypad” on page 4-2.  
• For details on deleting an address book number, see page 2-10 to 2-11.  
• For details on dialing using the address book, see “How to dial using address  
book” on page 2-12.  
• For details on call group dialing, see “Call group dialing” on page 2-14.  
Entering an e-mail address using the QWERTY keypad  
Enter the e-mail address using the QWERTY keypad.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2)  
3
Press “e-mail” tab, [Mail Address].  
4
4-2  
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Enter the e-mail address using the numeric keys and/or the QWERTY key-  
5
pad  
.
1
2
3
4
• Up to 50 characters can be entered for each e-mail address.  
• For details on character entry, see“Entering characters” on page 1-10.  
NOTE:  
5
(2) Press [Enter].  
Press [Start].  
6
6
Re-mail  
7
Press [Re-mail] to display the last e-mail address you sent to.  
8
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
9
2
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2)  
3
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Others], [Prev] or [Next], [Re-mail].  
4
You can assign [Re-mail] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
NOTE:  
(When “All” tab is selected)  
The last destination that you sent to will be displayed.  
• Press [Location] to review or delete the specified destinations.  
• Press [To] to toggle between[To], [Cc] and [Bcc].  
NOTE:  
Press [Start].  
5
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mail History  
The latest 20 e-mail addresses that you manually entered and sent to will be dis-  
played. You may select a number to send to.  
*E-mail addresses will not repeat on the list, even if the address has been sent to  
multiple times.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2)  
3
Press [Mail History].  
4
(When “All” tab is selected)  
(1) Select the e-mail address you want to send to.  
5
Up to 20 e-mail addresses will be listed, with the most recent communication  
listed first.  
NOTE:  
4-4  
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The selected destination will be displayed.  
1
2
3
After you edit the e-mail address, go to step (2). For details on character entry,  
see “Entering characters” on page 1-10.  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
4
(2) Press [Enter].  
5
Press [Location] to review or delete the entered destinations.  
• Press [To] to toggle between [To], [Cc] and [Bcc].  
6
Press [Start].  
6
7
You can register the destination in the address book from the display in step 5 (1).  
1 Press [Register].  
2 Following the steps from step 6 in “Registering an e-mail address using the  
QWERTY keypad”. For details, see page 2-9.  
NOTE:  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-5  
Reviewing or canceling commands  
For details on the Reviewing Commands feature, see “Chapter 6 Reviewing or  
canceling commands”.  
Advanced mail functions  
The table below lists the advanced functions that can be used in the Fax mode.  
To select an advanced mail function:  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
Press [Others].  
2
Press [Prev] or [Next] and select the advanced function.  
3
See the page numbers indicated for detailed information.  
NOTE: If you regularly use an advanced function you can register that function as a  
default soft key, providing instant recall. (See page 10-2.)  
Advanced function Descriptions  
Reference  
p. 4-2  
Mail Address  
Mail History  
Use this to manually enter an e-mail address.  
Displays a history of manually entered e-mail  
addresses (up to 20).  
p. 4-4  
Re-mail  
Displays the last e-mail address that you sent  
to.  
p. 4-3  
p. 4-7  
e-mail Subject  
Add a subject line and text message to your  
e-mail transmission.  
Batch Scan  
Check Mail  
Enable or disable batch scanning.  
p. 4-11  
p. 4-12  
Check for new e-mail documents that have  
arrived.  
File Format  
Select the file format of your attachment.  
p. 4-13  
You can select the following functions when sending an Internet fax. (For  
details on the following functions, see “Advanced fax functions” on page 3-23.)  
NOTE:  
• Broadcast transmission  
• Fax&Copy  
• Security reception  
• Cover page  
• Address book  
• Group transmission  
• TTI select  
• Transmission report  
• Scan size  
• Delayed transmission  
4-6  
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adding a text message to your e-mail  
When you send a document to an e-mail address, a fixed subject and text are  
entered automatically. However you can manually enter an e-mail subject line and  
text to the transmission.  
Editing the subject line and text message  
1
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
2
Press [Others], [Prew] or [Next].  
3
3
Press [e-mail Subject].  
4
4
5
6
7
8
(When “All” tab is selected)  
9
NOTE: You can assign [e-mail Subject] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
Press [Subject].  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
6
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4-7  
Enter the subject. The subject can contain up to 80 characters.  
6
Press [Enter].  
7
8
Press [Mail Text].  
Enter the text message.  
9
NOTE: The mail text can contain up to 1024 characters. “Return” is counted as two  
characters and can be used twice.  
4-8  
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To view the entire text message, press [View Text].  
Use the arrows to view all the text. Press [Enter] to close to return to the  
QWERTY keypad.  
10  
1
2
3
4
Press [Enter] until address book appears.  
Select a destination(s).  
11  
12  
13  
5
6
Press [Start].  
Using a registered template  
7
You can select a registered template to simplify the entry process. You can register  
up to ten templates.  
8
NOTE: The template should be registered in advance. (See the “Network Guide” for  
instruction.)  
9
Set the document.  
1
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Press [Others], [Prev] or [Next].  
3
Press [e-mail Subject].  
4
Press [Template].  
5
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select the desired template.  
If the desired template is not shown on the display, press [Page Up] or [Page  
Down] to go to the next page.  
6
Press [Enter].  
7
8
If you want to edit the subject or the text message, select either [Subject] or  
[Mail Text] and edit it. Refer steps 6 to 11 on page 4-8 for instructions.  
Specify the destination(s).  
9
Press [Start].  
10  
Changing the default text message  
You can change the default template setting for the subject line and text message.  
See “Mail Settings” on page 12-9.  
For details, see “Adding a text message to your e-mail” on page 4-7, 5-24.  
4-10 INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Batch scanning  
When you select [OFF], each page in the transmission will be sent as an individual  
file (each page will also be a seperate transmission). The default setting is [ON].  
You can change the default setting for batch scan. See “Mail Settings” on page  
12-9.  
NOTE:  
1
Set the document.  
1
2
3
4
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Adjust the scanning resolution and contrast, if necessary. (See page 3-2)  
Press [Others], [Prev] or [Next], [Batch Scan].  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
(When “All” tab is selected)  
9
You can assign [Batch Scan] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
(1) Press [OFF].  
NOTE:  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
5
(2) Press [Enter] twice.  
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS 4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the e-mail address.  
You can specify it selecting an address book entry, address book number or by  
entering it manually.  
6
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See page  
3-24) or call group dialing (See page 2-14).  
Press [Reset] to cancel the settings.  
Press [Start].  
7
(If you specify the destination using the address book, no need to press [Start].)  
Checking for new e-mail  
• There are two methods for receiving internet faxes using POP, as described below.  
1. At specified time intervals  
2. Real-time  
• If you receive only a few documents each day, or you want to check the reception  
immediately, use the real-time method.  
• This manual describes the real-time only.  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
Press [Others], [Prev] or [Next], [Check Mail].  
2
(When “All” tab is selected)  
You can assign [Check Mail] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
NOTE:  
4-12 INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifying the attachment file format  
• When sending to a PC, the scanned document will be sent as e-mail attachment  
file.  
• Select the attachment format from the following: [TIFF-S], [TIFF] or [PDF].  
• [TIFF-S].....This form is for ITU-T T.37 simple mode. The scanned document is  
converted into A4 size at 200 dpi. Select TIFF-S when the remote  
Internet fax machine cannot receive a TIFF.  
• [TIFF].........This form is for ITU-T T.37 full mode. The scanned document is  
transmitted in its original scanned parameter. TIFF file format is the  
approved standard for Internet Faxing.  
1
2
• [PDF]..........PDF is only available when sending to a PC.  
3
You can change the default setting for file format. See “Mail Settings” on page  
12-9.  
NOTE:  
4
Set the document.  
1
2
3
4
5
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Press [Others], [Prev] or [Next], [FileFormat].  
(1) Select the file format.  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Color scanning is not compatible with Internet faxing. For details on color scan-  
ning, see “Scan to e-mail” on page 5-9.  
NOTE:  
(2) Press [Enter] twice.  
INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS 4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the e-mail address.  
You can specify it using the address book or by entering it manually.  
5
• When specifying multiple destinations, use broadcast transmission (See page  
3-24.) or call group dialing. (See page 2-14.)  
Press [Reset] to cancel the settings.  
Press [Start].  
6
(If you specify the destination using the address book, no need to press [Start].)  
4-14 INTERNET FAX FUNCTIONS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
5
Scanning  
Before scanning......................................................................................5-2  
Resolution........................................................................................5-2  
Contrast...........................................................................................5-3  
Document type ................................................................................5-4  
Scan size..........................................................................................5-5  
Entering the file name....................................................................5-6  
Scan to e-mail.........................................................................................5-9  
Sending a document by e-mail.......................................................5-9  
Selecting a destination from the Address Book ..........................5-11  
Searching for an e-mail address ..................................................5-15  
Sending a document using the mail history................................5-21  
Re-mail ..........................................................................................5-22  
Reviewing or changing your selected destinations .....................5-23  
Adding a text message to your e-mail..........................................5-24  
Scan to folder........................................................................................5-28  
Scanning documents into a folder................................................5-28  
Scanning documents using a folder shortcut ..............................5-33  
Reviewing or canceling selected folders ......................................5-34  
Registering or editing a folder shortcut.......................................5-35  
Scan to FTP..........................................................................................5-42  
Scanning documents to an FTP server........................................5-42  
Registering an FTP server to a shortcut .....................................5-45  
Scanning documents using an FTP shortcut ..............................5-47  
Reviewing or canceling selected FTP servers .............................5-48  
Registering or editing an FTP server shortcut ...........................5-49  
Advanced functions..............................................................................5-56  
Color ..............................................................................................5-56  
Zoom ..............................................................................................5-57  
Batch scanning..............................................................................5-59  
Selecting the file format ...............................................................5-60  
Duplex scanning ...........................................................................5-61  
Broadcasting .................................................................................5-63  
Attaching additional files to the scanned document...................5-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before scanning  
You can customize your job prior to scanning.  
Resolution  
You can select either 200 dpi, 300 dpi or 600 dpi scan resolutions for monochrome  
scanning, or 100dpi, 200dpi, 300dpi or 600 dpi scan resolution for color scanning.  
Scanning at 600 dpi provides greater detail in scanned images, but creates large  
files and uses more PC and machine-based memory. Color documents scanned at  
600 dpi data may not appear correctly in your application software.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
Press [Resolution].  
2
3
Select the desired resolution.  
4
Press [Enter].  
5
NOTE: • When you are scanning monochrome documents, the color resolutions are  
grayed out. To scan a color document, first toggle [Color] to [ON], and the  
color resolution setting will become available.  
You can change the default setting for [Resolution]. See “Accessing the default  
scan settings” on page 12-7.  
5-2  
SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contrast  
Adjusting the scan contrast allows you to compensate for any excessive lightness or  
darkness of the documents you are scanning.  
NOTE: This function is not available when scanning a color document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
2
2
Press [Contrast].  
3
3
4
5
6
7
8
Press to left to lighten, press to right to darken.  
4
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter].  
5
To avoid confusing the Light and Dark settings, just remember, — Light light-  
ens” and “Dark darkens” — to keep it straight.  
You can change the default setting for [Contrast]. See “Accessing the default  
scan settings” on page 12-7.  
NOTE:  
SCANNING  
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Document type  
Select the document type you want to scan.  
NOTE: This function is not available when scanning a color document.  
Text........Select this when scanning text documents.  
Auto.......Select this when scanning documents containing photographs or drawings  
with text.  
Photo .....Select this when scanning photographs or drawings.  
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
2
Press [Doc. Type].  
3
Select the desired document type.  
4
Press [Enter].  
5
You can change the default setting for [Doc.Type]. See “Accessing the default  
scan settings” on page 12-7.  
NOTE:  
5-4  
SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan size  
You can change the document scan size prior to scanning. The machine scans  
the range of the document according to the selected size. It will start scanning at  
the front side of the document which may eliminate or cut off the backside of the  
scanned document.  
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
1
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
2
2
Press [Others].  
3
Press [Scan Size].  
4
3
4
5
6
7
8
You can assign [Scan Size] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
Select the desired scan size.  
NOTE:  
9
5
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter].  
6
SCANNING  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering the file name  
You can add a file name to the document prior to scanning. The name can contain  
up to 20 characters. You can also register up to 10 file names in advance, allowing  
for quick access.  
If you do not enter a file name prior to scanning, the scanned date and time will be  
used as the file name. For example, if the document is scanned on 26 September  
2005 on 2:15 p.m.30 second, the file will be named 20050926141530. Also, if the  
name you use for the file already exists, the scan date and time will be added to the  
end of the file name to give it differentation.  
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
2
Press [File Name].  
3
If you have chosen [Folder] or [FTP], [File Name] is located on the default  
screen. If you have chosen [e-mail], press [Others] to locate [File Name].  
You can assign [File Name] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
Enter the file name.  
NOTE:  
4
To use a pre-registered file name, proceed to step 5.  
Otherwise skip to step 8.  
NOTE: You cannot enter a space as the first letter of the file name.  
• The characters available for the file name are alphabetical, numeral and  
special characters listed as below.  
• Avairable special characters:  
_
)
.
@
;
-
,
&
]
!
#
{
$
}
%
~
)
+
=
[
^
5-6  
SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [List].  
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
Select a name.  
4
5
6
7
8
9
Edit the name, if needed.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter].  
NOTE: To use the pre-registered fine names, the names should be entered in advance.  
See “Registering or editing file names” next page how to register file names.  
SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-7  
Registering or editing file names  
NOTE: You can register up to 10 file names.  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Scanner Settings].  
2
Press [File Name].  
3
To register a new file name, select an empty key. To edit a file name, select the  
desired file name to edit.  
4
Enter or edit the file name, then press [Enter].  
5
The name can contain up to 20 characters. Refer to page 5-6 for available char-  
acters.  
To return to the Standby mode, press [Reset].  
6
5-8  
SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan to e-mail  
Sending a document by e-mail  
You can send a hardcopy document to an e-mail inbox.  
Set the document.  
1
2
3
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
Press [e-mail].  
2
3
4
5
6
7
Adjust any scan settings or set any advanced functions.  
4
For more information about those functions, see “Before scanning” on pages 5-2  
to 5-8 and “Advanced functions” on pages 5-56 to 5-66.  
8
To insert a text message into your e-mail, see pages 5-24 to 5-27.  
Press [Mail Address].  
5
6
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Use the QWERTY keypad or numeric keys to enter the e-mail address. The  
address may contain up to 50 characters.  
7
SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5-9  
To enter symbols, press [Symbol].  
To delete a character, press [ ] [ ] to move the cursor to the character you  
want to delete and press [Delete].  
For more information on entering characters, refer to pages 1-10 to 1-13 “Enter-  
ing characters”.  
There are several other ways in which to enter an e-mail address:  
• Select an Address Book entry (See page 5-11 to 5-15)  
• LDAP directory search (See pages 5-15 to 5-19)  
• E-mail history (See pages 5-21 to 5-22)  
• Re-mail (See page 5-22)  
If you select a destination from the Address Book, the machine will begin scan-  
ning as soon as the destination is selected. Otherwise proceed to step 8.  
If you have selected multiple destinations and would like to review them, see  
page 5-23. Otherwise proceed to step 8.  
Press [Start].  
8
Registering the entered e-mail address to the address book  
If you entered an e-mail address and wish to register it into your machine-side  
address book, please follow these steps:  
After you have entered the e-mail address, press [Register].  
1
Select an address book entry number using [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys. You  
cannot select a number that has been registered.  
2
Press [Yes].  
3
5-10 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the [Name], [Fax No] or [Group] information as needed. The [Name] field  
must be registered.  
4
For more information how to enter them, see “Regitering or editing an address  
book number“ from page 2-4.  
1
2
3
4
5
Press [Enter].  
5
6
Selecting a destination from the Address Book  
7
You can register 300 frequently used e-mail and fax numbers in advance. Once the  
numbers/addresses are registered, they will be displayed on the display for instant  
recall.  
8
NOTE: The e-mail destination or the group information should be registered in  
advance. For more information, see chapter 2 “Resitering destinations in  
Address Book” on pages 2-4 to 2-11.  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
NOTE: If you select a destination from the default mode screen, the machine will  
automatically start scanning. If you want to select multiple destinations, press  
[Broadcast] prior to selecting destinations.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [e-mail].  
3
Select the desired destination(s) from the display.  
4
SCANNING 5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the registered destination is not shown on the display, press [Page Up] or  
[Page Down] to toggle through the directory.  
5
Go to the next section to learn how to use these functions.  
Using [Index]  
If you have numerous contacts registered in your address book, you may find the  
[Index] a useful tool in finding them.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [e-mail].  
3
Press [Index].  
4
Select the corresponding button that contains the first letter of the name. If the  
destination begins with a symbol, select [Symbol]. To view the contacts by their  
Address Book number, select [Numeric].  
5
5-12 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The entries will now be displayed based on your selection. If you have multiple  
contacts registered, use the [Page Up] and [Page Down] to toggle through the  
directory.  
6
1
2
3
4
Select the desired destination(s).  
7
5
Using [Group]  
If you regularly send the same document to multiple parties, you can utilize the  
group function to automatically select these users.  
6
Set the document.  
1
7
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
8
Press [e-mail].  
3
Press [Index].  
4
9
Press [Group].  
5
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
SCANNING 5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select the desired group(s).  
You can even choose [Non Group Members] to select a destination that is not  
associated with a group.  
6
Press [Enter].  
7
Using address book number  
If you know the address book number, you can quickly send to that location by  
entering that number. The destinations are numbered when they are registered.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [e-mail].  
3
Press [Others].  
4
Press [Address Book].  
5
You can assign [Address Book] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
NOTE:  
5-14 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Use [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys and enter the address book number.  
6
1
2
3
Press [Enter].  
7
4
5
Searching for an e-mail address  
You can quickly search for a contact located in your machine-side address book or  
on an LDAP server.  
6
NOTE: In order to search an LDAP server, the server must be registered in advance.  
7
For more information about set up, see the “Network Guide”.  
8
Simple search  
You can search for an e-mail address by entering the contact name, part of the  
contact name or a part of the e-mail address.  
9
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [e-mail].  
2
Press [Search].  
3
SCANNING 5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Use the QWERTY keypad or numeric keys to enter criteria. This should contain  
the contact name, part of the contact name or part of the e-mail address.  
4
Press [Execute].  
5
6
Every name and e-mail address including the criteria will be displayed. If there  
are no results, “Hit:0000” will be displayed.  
Press [Page Up] and [Page Down] to search the results.  
If the address displayed is from the LDAP server, it will have an  
next to it.  
Select this button to view the contact information and/or register the contact  
into your address book. Press [Close] to close the window.  
If your search yields too many contacts, select [Narrow List] to further narrow  
your search.  
7
8
9
If you want to start a new search, press [New Search] and search again. Refer  
to steps 4 to 6 how to search .  
Continue searching until you find your desired contact(s). If you press [Back] on  
the “Simple Search” screen you will return to the “Search Results” screen.  
• Press [Cancel] to return to the standby screen.  
Select the desired destination(s).  
10  
NOTE: If you cannot find your desired contact(s), please confirm that the search  
criteria was entered correctly. If this does not solve the problem, contact your  
network administrator.  
5-16 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced search  
You can add more criteria to your search by selecting [Advanced].  
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
2
3
4
Press [e-mail].  
Press [Search].  
1
Press [Advanced].  
2
3
4
5
6
Enter your search criteria. Select [AND] or [OR]. Refer to the table below for  
definitions.  
7
5
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
And ........... Searches for contacts that meet all the entered criteria.  
Or .............. Searches for contacts that meet any of the entered criteria.  
Name ........ Enter a name or a part of a name to be searched.  
Fax ............ Enter a fax number or a part of a fax number to be searched.  
e-mail ........ Enter part of the e-mail address to be searched.  
Dept. .......... This means department. It is not an independent field. To use this  
field either the Name, Fax or e-mail should also be entered.  
NOTE: • If you are entering the e-mail field, you may select [Copy Name]. This will  
import information that has been entered in the “Name” field.  
• If too many special characters (such as umlaut) are entered in each field,  
the message “LDAP reference execution error” may appear and the LDAP  
searching will not be performed. In this case, decrease the special character  
entering.  
SCANNING 5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NOTE: [Not Use] is the default search criteria. If you enter character(s) in the Name,  
Fax or e-mail field this button will change to [Any]. If you want to use criteria  
other than [Any], select this button to view other selection.  
Press [Any] to change the criterion, if needed.  
6
Select desired criterion.  
Any ............ Searches any information in this field, including “blanks”.  
Initial ........ Searches for contacts that begin with the characters entered in this  
field.  
Final ......... Searches for contacts that end with the characters entered in this  
field.  
Equal ........ Searches for contacts that match exactly with the information  
entered in this field.  
Not Use ..... Information in this field (including blanks) will not be used for  
searching.  
Press [Enter].  
7
Press [Execute].  
8
5-18 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The search results will be displayed. If there are no results, “Hit:0000” will be  
displayed.  
9
Press [Page Up] and [Page Down] to view all the results.  
If the address displayed is from the LDAP server, it will have an  
next to it.  
Select this button to view the contact information and/or register the contact  
into your address book. Select [Close] to close the window.  
1
2
3
4
5
If your search yields too many contacts, select [Narrow List] to futher narrow  
your search. Refer to steps 5 to 8 how to search.  
6
10  
11  
12  
7
If you want to start a new search, press [New Search] and search again. Refer  
to steps 5 to 8 how to search.  
8
Continue searching until you find your desired contact(s). If you press [Back] on  
the “Advanced Search” screen you will return to the “Search Results” screen.  
9
• Press [Cancel] to return to the standby screen.  
Select the desired destination(s).  
13  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
NOTE: If you cannot find your contact(s), please confirm that the search criteria was  
entered correctly. If this does not solve the problem, ask your network adminis-  
trator.  
Registering a destination from the search results screen  
If you locate a contact on an LDAP server and wish to register them into your  
machine-side address book, please follow these steps:  
Execute either a simple search or advanced search.  
1
SCANNING 5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Once the “Search Results” screen appears, select the  
wish to register.  
next to the contact you  
2
Press [Register].  
3
4
Select an address book entry number using [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys. You  
cannot select a number that has already been registered.  
Press [Yes].  
5
6
Enter the [Name], [Fax No] or [Group] information as needed. The [Name] field  
must be registered.  
For more information how to enter them, see “Regitering or editing an address  
book number“ from page 2-4.  
Press [Enter].  
7
8
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
5-20 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a document using the mail history  
The last 20 manually entered e-mail locations you sent will be stored in the mail  
history. You can send documents to these locations by simply selecting them from  
this listing.  
NOTE: E-mail addresses registered in the address book will not appear in the mail his-  
tory. Only the last 20 addresses entered manually will be displayed in the order  
in which they were sent (most recent location listed first). The same location  
will not appear multiple times on this list, the last time in which it was used.  
1
2
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
3
Press [e-mail].  
2
Press [Others].  
3
4
Press [Mail History].  
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
You can assign [Mail History] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
NOTE:  
Select the desired e-mail address. Use [Prev] or [Next] to toggle through the  
e-mail history.  
5
SCANNING 5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you want to edit an existing e-mail address, use the QWERTY keypad or  
numeric keys to do so.  
6
Press [Enter].  
7
Re-mail  
This button will recall the last e-mail address you sent to.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [e-mail].  
3
Press [Others].  
4
Press [Re-mail].  
5
You can assign [Re-mail] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
The last used e-mail address you sent to will be displayed.  
NOTE:  
6
5-22 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reviewing or changing your selected destinations  
When you have entered multiple destinations, you can review, cancel or change the  
broadcast status of the destinations.  
NOTE: This function is only available prior to scanning the document.  
After the destinations have been entered, press [Location].  
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
Press [Page Up] or [Page Down]and review all the entered e-mail and folder  
destinations.  
2
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Every time you press [To], the status changes from [To] to [Cc], then [Bcc] in  
3
that order. Press the key until it changes to your desired status.  
Pressing [Sort] will sort the e-mail destinations in [To], [Cc] and [Bcc] order.  
To delete e-mail or folder destinations, select the destinations to delete and  
press [Delete].  
4
Press [Enter] to return to screen 1.  
5
SCANNING 5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adding a text message to your e-mail  
When you send a document to an e-mail address, a fixed subject and text are  
entered automatically. However you can manually enter an e-mail subject line and  
text to the transmission.  
Editing the subject line and text message  
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [e-mail].  
3
Press [Others].  
4
Press [e-mail Subject].  
5
You can assign [e-mail Subject] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
Press [Subject].  
NOTE:  
6
5-24 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the subject. The subject can contain up to 80 characters.  
7
1
2
3
Press [Enter].  
8
9
4
Press [Mail Text].  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Enter the text message.  
10  
NOTE: The mail text can contain up to 1024 characters. “Return” is counted as two  
characters and can be used twice.  
SCANNING 5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To view the entire text message, press [View Text]. Use the arrows to view all  
the text. Press [Enter] to close to return to the QWERTY keypad.  
11  
Press [Enter].  
12  
13  
14  
Select a destination(s).  
Press [Start].  
Using a registered template  
You can select a registered template to simplify the entry process. You can register  
up to ten templates.  
NOTE: The template should be registered in advance. (See the “Network Guide” for  
instruction.)  
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [e-mail].  
3
Press [Others].  
4
Press [e-mail Subject].  
5
Press [Template].  
6
5-26 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select the desired template.  
If the desired template is not shown on the display, press [Page Up] or [Page  
Down] to go to the next page.  
7
1
2
3
4
Press [Enter].  
8
9
5
If you want to edit the subject or the text message, select either [Subject] or  
[Mail Text] and edit it. Refer steps 6 to 12 on pages 5-24 to 5-26 for instructions.  
6
Select a destination(s).  
Press [Start].  
10  
11  
7
8
Changing the default text message  
Press [Setting] on the control panel.  
1
9
Press [Mail Settings].  
2
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Subject].  
3
Press [ON], then [Enter].  
4
Select the desired template, and press [Enter].  
5
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
6
SCANNING 5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan to folder  
Scanning documents into a folder  
You can scan a document directly into a network folder.  
NOTE: To save a scanned document to a folder, you should have a shared folder in your  
computer. Create a shared folder in advance, referring to your PC manual if  
necessary.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [Folder].  
3
Adjust the scan settings, or set advanced functions.  
4
For more information about those functions, see “Before scanning” on pages 5-2  
to 5-8 and “Advanced functions” on pages 5-56 to 5-66.  
Press [Browse]. The “Network Navigation” screen will be displayed.  
5
The following folders will not be browsed from your machine:  
• Folders that are not in the same segment with your machine.  
• Folders that name contain 13 or more characters.  
NOTE:  
• Folders that link contain more than 100 characters in length.  
5-28 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
All accessible networks will be displayed. To scroll, use [Page Up] and [Page  
Down].  
6
1
2
3
4
Select the network that contains your desired folder.  
7
8
Search through the network folders until you find the specific folder you wish to  
scan to.  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• To go up one step, press [Back].  
• To return to the first screen, press [Root].  
If the user name and password are required to login to the file server, press  
[UserName]. Otherwise skip to step 13.  
9
SCANNING 5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the user name, then press [Enter].  
10  
If your machine is on a windows domain controlled network, add the domain  
name after the user name with an “@”, like “sam@dom_muratec”.  
The user name can contain up to 50 characters.  
All ASCII characters are available.  
Press [Password].  
11  
Enter the password, then press [Enter].  
The password can contain up to 32 characters.  
All ASCII characters are available.  
12  
NOTE: The entered password is displayed using asterisks.  
Press [Start].  
13  
5-30 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering a folder shortcut from the browse screen  
After you find the folder you wish to scan to you may register it as a folder shortcut, allowing  
for instant network scanning to a specified folder. Up to 20 shortcuts can be registered.  
After you locate your desired folder, select the location and press [Bookmark].  
1
1
2
3
4
5
Select a shortcut number using [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys. You can select  
either a new number, or overwrite an existing number.  
2
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select [Yes].  
3
4
Register the [Shortcut], [User Name] and [Password] as needed.  
Shortcut Name — This is the name that will be displayed on the shortcut  
key. The name can contain up to 24 characters. If you do not register a short-  
cut name, the folder link will be displayed on the shortcut key.  
User Name, Password — If you have entered an user name and password  
they will be displayed (the password will be displayed using asterisks).  
SCANNING 5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To Enter the Shortcut name, press [Shortcut Name].  
Enter a shortcut name, then press [Enter].  
5
6
The name can contain up to 24 characters. If you do not register a shortcut  
name, the folder link will be displayed on the shortcut key. When the link is too  
long to be displayed on the key, it will be omitted at the center with “.” and only  
the beginning and ending of the link will be displayed.  
Press [Enter].  
7
• To finish without registering the shortcut, press [Cancel].  
• To return to the screen in step 4, press [Back].  
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
8
To edit or delete the shortcut information, see “Resitering or editing a folder  
shortcut” on pages 5-35 to 5-41.  
5-32 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scanning documents using a folder shortcut  
NOTE: The folders should be registered in advance. For more information, see “Resiter-  
ing or editing a folder shortcut” on pages 5-35 to 5-41.  
NOTE: Scanning will begin once the shortcut key has been pressed. If you want to scan  
to multiple folder shortcuts, select [Broadcast] prior to destination selection.  
1
Set the document.  
1
2
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
3
Press [Folder].  
3
4
Select the desired shortcut key on the display.  
If it is not displayed, press [Page Up] or [Page Down].  
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
SCANNING 5-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reviewing or canceling selected folders  
You can quickly review or cancel the folders you selected.  
NOTE: This function is only available prior to scanning the document.  
After the destinations have been selected, press [Location].  
1
Press [Page Up] or [Page Down] and review all the entered folders and e-mail  
destinations.  
2
Every time you press [To], the status changes from [To] to [Cc], then [Bcc] in  
that order. Press the key until it changes to your desired status.  
3
Pressing [Sort] will sort the e-mail destinations in [To], [Cc] and [Bcc] order.  
To delete e-mail or folder destinations, select the destinations to delete and  
press [Delete].  
4
Press [Enter] to return to screen 1.  
5
5-34 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering or editing a folder shortcut  
Registering a folder shortcut  
You can create a folder shortcut on your machine.  
NOTE: You can register up to 20 shortcuts.  
1
Press [Setting].  
1
2
Press [Scanner Settings].  
2
3
4
5
6
7
Press [Folder Shortcut].  
3
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Add/Edit].  
4
SCANNING 5-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select an empty key.  
5
6
7
Press [Shortcut Name].  
Enter a shortcut name, then press [Enter].  
The name can contain up to 24 characters. If you do not register a shortcut  
name, the folder link will be displayed on the shortcut key. When the link is too  
long to be displayed on the key, it will be omitted at the center with “.” and only  
the beginning and ending of the link will be displayed.  
5-36 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Link]. The “Network Navigation” screen will be displayed.  
8
1
2
3
All accessible networks will be displayed. To scroll, use the [Page Up] and [Page  
Down].  
9
4
5
6
7
8
9
NOTE: If you want to directly specify a folder using the QWERTY keypad, press [Key-  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
pad]. Then enter a link and press [Enter].  
Search through the network folders until you find the specific folder you wish to  
10  
register to, and press [Enter].  
• To go up one step, press [Back].  
• To return to the first screen, press [Root].  
NOTE: The link should be within 100 characters in length.  
SCANNING 5-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the user name and password are required to login to the file server, press  
[UserName]. Otherwise skip to step 15.  
11  
Enter the user name, then press [Enter].  
12  
If your machine is on a windows domain controlled network, add the domain  
name after the user name with an “@”, like “sam@dom_muratec”.  
The user name can contain up to 50 characters.  
All ASCII characters are available.  
Press [Password].  
13  
5-38 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter a password, then press [Enter].  
The password can contain up to 32 characters.  
All ASCII characters are available.  
14  
1
2
3
4
5
NOTE: The entered password is displayed using asterisks.  
Press [Enter].  
6
15  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
If you want to register more shortcuts, repeat the procedures from step 5.  
16  
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
17  
SCANNING 5-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing a folder shortcut  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Scanner Settings], [Folder Shortcut], [Add/Edit].  
2
3
4
Select the shortcut you want to edit.  
Edit the desired field.  
After editing, press [Enter].  
5
6
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
5-40 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting a folder shortcut  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Scanner Settings], [Folder Shortcut], [Delete].  
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
Select the shortcut you want to delete.  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Yes] to delete.  
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
SCANNING 5-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan to FTP  
Scanning documents to an FTP server  
You can easily scan a document(s) to an FTP server.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [FTP].  
3
Adjust the scan settings, or set any advanced functions.  
4
For more information about those functions, see “Before scanning” on pages 5-2  
to 5-8 and “Advanced functions” on pages 5-56 to 5-66.  
Press [Host].  
5
5-42 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Link].  
6
1
2
3
Enter the link to the FTP server. The entry can contain up to 100 characters.  
Begin your entry with “//”.  
7
4
The “/(slash)” in found in the [Symbol] menu. To switch back to the alphabet,  
press [Alpha].  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter].  
8
9
Press [User name].  
SCANNING 5-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the user name using the QWERTY keypad and numeric keys. The user  
name can contain up to 50 characters. All ASCII characters are available.  
10  
Press [Enter].  
11  
12  
Press [Password].  
Enter the password using the QWERTY keyboard and numeric keys. The pass-  
word can contain up to 32 characters. All ASCII characters are available.  
13  
NOTE: The entered password is displayed using asterisks.  
Press [Enter].  
14  
5-44 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Enter].  
15  
1
2
3
Press [Start].  
16  
4
5
Registering an FTP server to a shortcut  
After you entered an FTP link, you may register it as a shortcut for instant recall.  
Up to 20 shortcuts can be registered.  
6
After you enter the [Link], [User Name] and [Password], press [Shortcut  
Name].  
1
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Register the [Shortcut Name].  
2
Shortcut Name — This is the name that will be displayed on the shortcut  
key. The name can contain up to 24 characters. If you do not register a name,  
the FTP link will be displayed on the shortcut key. When the link is too long  
to be displayed on the key, it will be omitted at the center with “.” and only  
the beginning and ending of the link will be displayed.  
SCANNING 5-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Enter].  
3
4
Press [Register].  
Select a shortcut number using [Page Up] and [Page Down] or the numeric  
keys. You can select either a new number, or overwrite a number that has been  
registered.  
5
Press [Yes].  
6
7
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
To edit or delete the shortcut information, see “Registering or editing an FTP  
server shortcut” on pages 5-49 to 5-55.  
5-46 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scanning documents using an FTP shortcut  
NOTE: The FTP server shortcut should be registered in advance. For more informa-  
tion, see “Registering or editing an FTP server shortcut” on pages 5-49 to 5-55.  
NOTE: Scanning will begin once the shortcut key has been pressed. If you want to  
scan to multiple FTP shortcuts, select the [Broadcast] prior to destination selec-  
tion.  
1
2
Set the document.  
1
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
3
Press [FTP].  
3
4
Select the desired shortcut. If it is not displayed, press [Page Up] or [Page  
Down].  
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
SCANNING 5-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reviewing or canceling selected FTP servers  
You can quickly review or cancel the FTP servers you have selected.  
Note: This function is only available prior to scanning the document.  
After the FTP servers have been selected, press [Location].  
1
Review the entered FTP servers.  
2
To delete a server(s), select the destination(s) you wish to delete and press  
[Delete].  
3
Press [Enter] to return to screen 1.  
4
5-48 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering or editing an FTP server shortcut  
Registering an FTP server shortcut  
You can create an FTP (File Transfer Protocol) shortcut on your machine.  
NOTE: You can register up to 20 shortcuts.  
1
Press [Setting].  
1
2
Press [Scanner Settings].  
2
3
4
5
6
7
Press [FTP Shortcut].  
3
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Add/Edit].  
4
SCANNING 5-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select an empty key.  
5
6
7
Press [Shortcut Name].  
Enter a shortcut name, then press [Enter].  
The name can contain up to 24 characters. If you do not register a name, the  
FTP link will be displayed on the shortcut key. When the link is too long to be  
displayed on the key, it will be omitted at the center with “.” and only the begin-  
ning and ending of the link will be displayed.  
5-50 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Link].  
8
1
2
3
Enter link, then press [Enter].  
Begin your entry with “//”.  
9
4
The “/(slash)” in found in the [Symbol] menu. To switch back to the alphabet,  
press [Alpha].  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [UserName].  
10  
SCANNING 5-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the user name, then press [Enter].  
11  
The user name can contain up to 50 characters. All ASCII characters are avail-  
able.  
Press [Password].  
12  
Enter the password, then press [Enter].  
13  
The password can contain up to 32 characters. All ASCII characters are avail-  
able.  
NOTE: The entered password is displayed using asterisks.  
5-52 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Enter].  
14  
1
2
3
If you want to register another shortcut, repeat procedure from step 5.  
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
15  
16  
4
5
NOTE: We recommend you to test your registered FTP Shortcut by sending something  
soon after your have registered it. It is the best way to verify that the registered  
Shortcut is all right.  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
SCANNING 5-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing an FTP shortcut  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Scanner Settings], [FTP Shortcut], [Add/Edit].  
2
3
4
Select the shortcut you want to edit.  
Edit the desired item.  
After editing, press [Enter].  
5
6
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
5-54 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting an FTP shortcut  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Scanner Settings], [FTP Shortcut], then [Delete].  
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
Select the shortcut you want to delete.  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Yes] to delete.  
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
SCANNING 5-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced functions  
Color  
Use this key to toggle the monochrome and color scan modes.  
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
Press [Color].  
1
2
3
The color scan mode is now activated.  
Press [Color] again to return to the monochrome scan setting.  
4
5-56 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Zoom  
Use this function to reduce or enlarge the document image.  
The available zoom ratio is as follows:  
Zoon ratio  
Range  
Resolution  
300dpi, 600dpi  
200dpi  
ADF  
50-100%  
Document glass  
50-200%  
1
75-100%  
75-200%  
Preset ratio  
300dpi, 600dpi  
50%, 64%, 78%, 100%  
50%, 64%, 78%, 100%, 121%,  
129%, 154%  
2
200dpi  
78%, 100%  
78%, 100%, 121%  
3
• For enlargement copy, you can only use the document glass (MFX-2030, MFX-  
1430 only).  
NOTE:  
• This function is not available when scanning a color document.  
You can assign [Zoom] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
4
5
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
Press [Others].  
1
2
3
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Zoom].  
4
SCANNING 5-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There are three ways to enter the zoom ratio.  
Select a preset zoom ratio key.  
5
• 50%  
• 64%: Letter (8.5” × 11”)  
• 78%: Legal (8.5” × 14”)  
• 100%  
Half-letter (5.5” × 8.5”)  
Letter (8.5” × 11”)  
• 121% : Legal (8.5” × 14”)  
• 129% : Letter (8.5” × 11”)  
11” × 17”  
11” × 17”  
• 154% : Half-letter (5.5” × 8.5”)  
– or –  
Legal (8.5” × 14”)  
Press [+] or [-] until your desired ratio is displayed.  
(50 to 200% for the document glass, 50 to 100% for the ADF.)  
– or –  
Enter your desired ratio using the numeric keys.  
Press [Enter].  
6
5-58 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Batch scanning  
When the “Batch Scan” function is on, it means that all scanned pages will be saved  
as one file. If you turn this function off, each scanned page will be saved as an indi-  
vidual file. Here is how:  
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
1
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
2
Press [Others].  
3
2
Press [Batch Scan].  
4
3
4
5
6
7
8
You can assign [Batch Scan] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
Press [OFF].  
NOTE:  
5
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter].  
6
NOTE: If you are scanning color documents and select [JPEG] as the file format, batch  
scanning will not be possible. Each scanned page will be saved as an individual  
JPEG. If you select batch scan when sending documents to an e-mail address,  
all of the scanned pages will appear as individual files but they will be sent in  
one e-mail.  
SCANNING 5-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting the file format  
You can select the file format for the scanned document.  
The following formats are available;  
Monochrome documents: TIFF or PDF  
Color documents: JPEG or PDF  
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
2
To scan color documents, press [Color] to toggle the key to [ON].  
3
Press [Others].  
4
Press [File Format].  
5
NOTE: You can assign [FileFormat] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” from page 10-2.  
Select the desired file format.  
6
This explanation shows the monochrome file format options. When color scan  
is activated, the settings for “Mono” are grayed out and the “Color” file formats  
are selectable.  
Press [Enter].  
7
You can change the default setting for [FileFormat]. See “Accessing the default  
scan settings” on page 12-7.  
NOTE:  
5-60 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Duplex scanning  
You can easily scan a two-sided document using this mode. Just load page one of  
the duplex document in the ADF and press [Start], the machine will prompt you on  
the following steps. The machine will automatically sort the pages into the correct  
order.  
NOTE: To use this function, the document type should be set first. The illustration  
1
below shows the alternative binding type of the duplex document.  
2
3
Top binding  
Right & Left binding  
4
Set the document.  
1
2
3
4
5
5
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
Press [Others].  
6
7
Press [DuplexScan].  
You can assign [DuplexScan] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
Select [ON].  
NOTE:  
8
6
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Advance].  
7
SCANNING 5-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Bind Right&Left].  
8
Select the binding position that suits your document.  
9
Press [Enter] three times.  
Select the desired destination.  
Press [Start].  
10  
11  
12  
13  
After the first side has been scanned, remove the document(s) from the output  
tray and insert them in the same direction as before.  
Press [Start] either using the key on the control panel or on the display. The  
machine will automatically sort the documents, you do not have to do this  
manually.  
14  
5-62 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Broadcasting  
Using this key, you can simultaneously send document to multiple destinations.  
NOTE: Broadcasting is available for e-mail and folders or for FTP servers. You can-  
not broadcast a document to an e-mail address or a folder, and an FTP server  
together.  
1
One broadcast can handle all 300 Address Book entries as well as 30 manually  
entered locations, for total of 330 locations. A broadcast can handle either 5 folder  
locations or 5 FTP servers.  
2
Set the document.  
1
3
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
2
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
4
3
Press [Others].  
4
5
Press [Broadcast] and toggle the switch to [ON].  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
You can assign [Broadcast] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
Press [Enter].  
NOTE:  
6
7
If you select a destination from address book or a folder/FTP shortcut, that  
location will be highlighted on the display.  
To review or cancel a destination(s), press [Location]. If you want to cancel a  
destination(s), select the destination(s) you want to remove and press [Delete].  
For more information about this display, see pages 5-23, 5-34 and 5-48.  
8
9
When all the desired destinations are selected, press [Start].  
SCANNING 5-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attaching additional files to the scanned document  
In addition to the document you are scanning, you may add up to 10 network files  
(or up to 10 MB files worth of files) to the job.  
To attach a file:  
Press [SCAN] on the control panel.  
1
Press [e-mail], [Folder] or [FTP].  
2
Press [Others].  
3
Press [Attachment].  
4
You can assign [Attachment] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-4.  
After browsing, all accessible networks will be displayed.  
NOTE:  
5
Select the network that contains your desired file. To scroll, use [Page Up] and  
[Page Down].  
6
The file should be under a shared folder that meets the following requirements:  
• The folder should be in the same segment with your machine.  
• The shared folder name should contain 12 or characters less.  
• The link to the folder should contain 100 characters or less in length.  
• The link to the file should be 128 characters or less in length.  
NOTE:  
5-64 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Search through the network folders until you find the folder in which the your  
desired file is.  
7
1
2
3
4
• To go up one step, press [Back].  
• To return to the first screen, press [Root].  
5
If the user name and password are required to login to the file server, enter  
[UserName] and [Password].  
8
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• Press [User Name], then enter the user name and press [Enter]. Refer to  
page 5-30 step 10 for more information.  
• Press [Password], then enter the password and press [Enter.]  
Select the file you want to attach by touching it (It will become highlighted).  
9
To review the document properties, press the  
Press [Enter].  
located next to the file.  
10  
SCANNING 5-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To attach more files, press [Browse] and repeat steps 5 to 10. Otherwise proceed  
to step 12.  
11  
To remove attachments, select the file you want to remove and press [Delete].  
Press [Enter].  
12  
13  
5-66 SCANNING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
6
Reviewing or canceling commands  
Reviewing or canceling commands .......................................................6-2  
To review or cancel a command .....................................................6-2  
Reviewing or canceling parts of a broadcast .................................6-4  
Printing a delayed command list ...................................................6-6  
Printing a stored document............................................................6-6  
View or print the results of a fax transaction ...............................6-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reviewing or canceling commands  
Your machine can store several “Jobs” in memory. It also keeps track of each com-  
mand by assigning it a command number, like “001.”  
Delayed commands, redial attempts and current transactions are all stored in your  
machine’s memory and given a command number.  
Your machine can store up to 100 delayed commands. It identifies each by a three-  
digit command number from 001 to 100.  
The Review Commands function gives you the power to check on each job (or  
command) in your machine’s memory. It also allows you to cancel a fax and e-mail  
transmission command.  
To review or cancel a command  
The operation differs depending on whether or not a document is currently being  
transmitted.  
Press [Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.].  
If your machine is attempting to perform a command, proceed to step 5.  
1
For details on canceling the group transmission and/or broadcast trans-  
mission in progress, refer to “Reviewing or canceling parts of a broadcast”  
on page 6-4.  
NOTE:  
Press [Delayed Commands].  
2
The currently stored command will be displayed.  
3
[BrdCast] will be displayed for group transmission and broadcast transmission.  
NOTE:  
6-2  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you want to cancel a command, select the command you want to cancel.  
4
5
The confirmation message will appear.  
Press [Yes] to cancel the selected command. Otherwise, press [No].  
1
2
3
4
NOTE:  
• If the selected command was being transmitted, communication will be can-  
celed.  
5
You can cancel the destinations for broadcast transmission individually when  
the broadcast command in progress (See “Reviewing or canceling parts of a  
broadcast” on page 6-4.).  
6
7
To cancel other command, repeat procedures from step 4.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
6
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-3  
Reviewing or canceling parts of a broadcast  
You can also review or cancel certain destinations within a broadcast.  
When the broadcast command is in progress, you can cancel the destinations  
individually. However, you cannot cancel the destinations individually for the  
reserved command such as with delayed transmission.  
NOTE:  
(Reserved documents mixed with fax and e-mail for broadcast transmissions  
will have different commands for fax and e-mail respectively. In this case, you  
can only cancel one of the commands.)  
Press [Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.], [Delayed Commands].  
1
Select the command you want to cancel.  
2
When the broadcast command you have selected is in progress, you can cancel  
the destinations individually.  
3
Go to the next step without pressing [Yes].  
Otherwise, go to the step 6.  
6-4  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To review or cancel the individual destinations within this broadcast, press  
[Detail].  
4
1
2
3
4
Press the destination you want to cancel.  
5
5
6
7
8
9
Press [Yes].  
6
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
If you want to cancel a different destination, go back to step 5.  
If you want to go back to reviewing or canceling another command, press  
[Enter].  
To stop reviewing or canceling commands, press [Reset].  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing a delayed command list  
Your machine can print a command list which shows the following:  
• The command number, the batch transmission box number and the internet fax  
command number  
• The phone number, the e-mail address and the address book number of the speci-  
fied destination  
• The start time (this appears in the DD,HH:MM format)  
• The function specified for the command (ex. Broadcast, Batch transmission) will  
be printed in “Note”.  
To print a delayed command list, press [Setting], [List], [Journal List], [Command  
List], then [Yes].  
Printing a stored document  
Your machine can print out documents stored for a delayed transmission.  
Press [Setting].  
1
Press [Store Doc Settings].  
2
Press [Print].  
3
Press [Command Doc.].  
4
6-6  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press the command document you want to print.  
5
1
2
3
Press [Yes]. The selected command document will be printed.  
6
4
5
6
7
8
9
The selected command document cannot be printed during a real time trans-  
mission or polling reception.  
NOTE:  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-7  
View or print the results of a fax transaction  
The transaction history can display the past transactions. The results for each  
transaction can be also displayed and printed.  
Press [Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.].  
1
(1) If a document is currently being transmitted, the following display will be  
2
shown.  
Otherwise, proceed to step 4.  
(2) Press [No].  
Be sure to press [No] to keep the current transmission. If you press [Yes],  
the currently transmitting document will be canceled.  
NOTE:  
The Delayed Commands list will be displayed.  
Press [Enter].  
3
4
Press [Show History].  
You can check the fax sending/receiving history, the mail sending history and  
the mail receiving history respectively.  
6-8  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking the fax sending/receiving history  
The sending/receiving history for the last 100 fax jobs can be displayed.  
Press [Show History].  
5
1
2
3
4
The fax sending/receiving history will be displayed.  
6
5
Select the transaction you want to display.  
7
6
The transaction results will be displayed.  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Yes] to print the transaction results.  
8
NOTE:  
• Regarding the error code in “Result” column, see “Error codes” on pages 14-24  
to 14-25.  
• In fax transaction results, “Tx Result” will be printed for fax transmissions,  
and “Rx Result” will be printed for fax receptions.  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-9  
Checking the mail sending history  
The transmission history for the last 50 Internet faxes and scan to e-mails can be  
displayed.  
Press [Mail report Tx.].  
5
The mail transmission history will be displayed.  
6
7
Select the transaction you want to display.  
The transaction result is displayed.  
Press [Yes] to print the transaction results.  
8
Regarding the error code in “Result” column, see “Error codes” on pages 14-24  
to 14-25.  
NOTE:  
6-10 REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking the mail reception history  
The reception history for the last 50 Internet faxes and scan to e-mails can be  
displayed.  
Press [Mail report Rx.].  
5
1
2
3
4
The mail reception history will be displayed.  
5
6
7
Select the transaction you want to display.  
The transaction result is displayed.  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Yes] to print the transaction results.  
8
The transaction results will be printed.  
Regarding the error code in “Result” column, see “Error codes” on pages 14-24  
to 14-25.  
NOTE:  
REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS 6-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6-12 REVIEWING OR CANCELING COMMANDS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
7
Copying  
Before copying........................................................................................7-2  
Document and paper handling.......................................................7-2  
Memory overflow message..............................................................7-2  
Making copies.........................................................................................7-3  
Making copies .................................................................................7-3  
Setting the next document .............................................................7-3  
Copying using both document glass and ADF...............................7-5  
Copy reservation.............................................................................7-7  
Basic copy settings.................................................................................7-8  
Document type ................................................................................7-8  
Contrast...........................................................................................7-9  
Number of copies.............................................................................7-9  
Advanced copy functions .....................................................................7-10  
Selecting the paper size................................................................7-11  
Zoom ratio .....................................................................................7-12  
Automatic sorting .........................................................................7-13  
Combine.........................................................................................7-14  
Duplex copy...................................................................................7-16  
Card Copy......................................................................................7-25  
Specifying the document size to copy ..........................................7-27  
Checking the copy print queue............................................................7-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before copying  
Document and paper handling  
Before you begin making copies, please read the information mentioned on pages  
1-24 to 1-32.  
Memory overflow message  
If the memory overflows while scanning the first page  
Press [Stop] to return to the standby mode.  
Change the resolution or wait until memory becomes available before trying to  
copy again.  
If the memory overflows while scanning page 2+  
• Press [Yes] to copy the stored pages.  
• Press [No] to cancel the copy job.  
Change the resolution or wait until memory becomes available before trying to  
copy again.  
The following display is shown when the documents still remain.  
NOTE:  
Press [Stop] to discharge the remaining documents.  
7-2  
COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Making copies  
Making copies  
Set the document. (See page 1-25)  
1
2
3
Press [COPY] to display the Copy standby mode.  
1
If neccessary, adjust the copy settings. See “Basic copy settings” on page 7-8  
To clear the settings, press [Reset].  
2
Press [Start].  
To stop copying, press [Stop].  
4
3
Setting the next document  
4
The next document can be set when performing Sort Copy (See page 7-13), Com-  
bined Copy (See page 7-14), Card Copy (See page 7-25) in order to scan a different  
document.  
The default setting for this mode is [NO] when using the ADF, and [Yes] when  
using the document glass.  
5
6
When using the ADF  
Set the document in the ADF. (See page 1-25)  
Set Sort Copy/Combine Copy.  
Press [Start].  
7
1
2
3
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Yes] while the document is being scanned.  
4
When the document has been scanned, set the next document.  
5
COPYING  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Next Doc]. The next document will be scanned.  
• The Next Doc setting can be deleted by pressing [Complete].  
6
• To scan another document, press [Yes] while the document is scanning.  
When using the document glass  
Set the document on the document glass. (See page 1-25.)  
1
2
3
Set Sort Copy/Combine Copy/ Card Copy.  
Press [Start].  
• Pressing [No] during document scanning will start the copying of all docu-  
ments when the scan has been completed.  
When scanning has been completed, set the next document (if a book, set the  
next page in place).  
4
7-4  
COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Next Doc]. The next document will be scanned.  
5
1
2
3
Press [Complete] when all the documents have been scanned.  
6
4
Copying using both document glass and ADF  
5
When the next document setting is activated you can make a copy using both the  
document glass and ADF.  
6
Set the document in the ADF or on the document glass.  
1
7
Set Sort Copy/Combine Copy.  
2
Card Copy cannot be used for Combine copy.  
Press [Start].  
NOTE:  
8
3
4
9
When the document has been loaded into the ADF, press [Yes] during scanning.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
When scanning has been completed, set the next document.  
5
When a document is loaded in the ADF, remove the document from the docu-  
ment glass.  
NOTE:  
COPYING  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Next Doc]. The next document will be scanned.  
• Press [Complete] to begin copying.  
6
(1) When the document is scanned using the document glass, select the docu-  
ment size.  
7
(2) Press [Enter].  
When the document is scanned using the document glass, press [Complete] to  
begin copying.  
8
• When the document is scanned using the ADF, copying will begin automati-  
cally.  
• To have the next document scanned, press [Next Doc] while the document is  
being scanned.  
NOTE:  
• The ADF’s default setting is set to [Complete]. To scan the next document,  
select [Next Doc] while the current document is being scanned. For the docu-  
ment glass, the default setting is [Next Doc].  
• Setting to [Complete] during scanning will begin copying of the scanned docu-  
ments.  
7-6  
COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copy reservation  
A different document can be set and reserved for copying even while another copy is  
being printed. After the current job has been printed the next job will begin, mean-  
ing you won’t have any downtime!  
“Copy Reserve Ready” will be displayed while the job is printing.  
1
1
2
3
4
5
Set the document you want to reserve.  
2
6
Adjust the copy settings. (See pages 7-8 to 7-9)  
3
7
Press [Start].  
4
8
Press [Yes] to perform copy reservation.  
The document will be scanned and copying will begin after the current job has  
finished.  
5
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
The copy queue can be checked. (See page 7-28)  
NOTE:  
COPYING  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Basic copy settings  
Document type  
300 dpi or 600 dpi can be selected for [Text] and [Photo]. Refer to the table below  
and select the appropriate resolution. The default setting is [Auto].  
Option  
Document type  
Resolution  
Auto  
Text  
Documents containing photographs or drawings 300 dpi  
with letters  
Documents with letters  
Photographs or drawings  
Documents with letters  
300 dpi  
300 dpi  
600 dpi*  
Photo  
Text High-Res  
Documents containing photographs or drawings 600 dpi*  
with letters  
Text&Photo High-  
Res  
600 dpi*  
Photo High-Res  
Photographs or drawings  
* This resolution requires more memory. If you try to copy several pages at once, the  
memory may overflow.  
To select the document type:  
Press [Doc. Type].  
1
Select the document type.  
2
Press [Enter].  
3
NOTE: You can change the default setting for [Doc.Type]. See “Accessing the copy set-  
tings” on page 12-3.  
7-8  
COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contrast  
You can lighten or darken the document pages you are copying.  
To change the contrast setting:  
Press [Contrast].  
1
1
Select one of the contrast types.  
2
2
3
4
5
6
Normal  
Darker  
Lighter  
Lightest  
7
Darkest  
Press [Enter].  
8
3
NOTE: You can change the default setting for [Contrast]. See “Accessing the copy set-  
9
tings” on page 12-3.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Number of copies  
Each job can contain up to 99 copies.  
Use the numeric keys to enter the desired number of copies (01-99).  
COPYING  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advanced copy functions  
The table below lists the advanced functions that can be used in the Copy mode.  
To select the advanced copy functions:  
Press [COPY] to display the Copy standby mode.  
1
Press [Others].  
2
Press the key you want to select.  
3
Refer to the pages indicated for detailed information.  
NOTE: You can assign a function that you frequently use to a soft key for instant  
recall. (See pages 10-2 to 10-6.)  
Advanced function  
Descriptions  
Reference Page  
p. 1-32  
Bypass  
Use this to set the paper type on the bypass  
tray.  
Zoom  
Use this to set the magnification for zoom copy. p. 7-12  
Sort  
Enable or disable the sort copy.  
p. 7-13  
p. 7-14  
p. 7-16  
p. 7-27  
p. 7-25  
Combine  
Duplex Copy *1  
Doc.Size  
Card Copy *2  
Enable or disable the combine copy.  
Enable or disable the duplex copy.  
Specify the size of the document to be copied.  
Enable or disable the card copy.  
*1 The duplex printing unit is required. [Duplex Copy] is displayed when the duplex  
printing unit is not installed.  
*2 Card Copy is available from document glass only. This function is not available  
for F-560/F-520.  
7-10 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting the paper size  
The machine will automatically select the appropriate paper to match the original  
document, however you can manually specify the paper all well.  
In addition, bypass copy is available using the bypass tray.  
Selecting the paper  
1
From the display, select the cassette containing the paper you want to use for copy-  
ing.  
2
3
4
5
6
• For bypass copy, use the following procedure to set the paper type.  
7
Press [Bypass].  
1
Press [Others], [Bypass] for MFX-2030/MFX-1430 model.  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select the paper type you want to use for copying.  
2
Press [Enter].  
3
COPYING 7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Zoom ratio  
This machine allows you to reduce the image you are copying.  
There are three ways to enter the zoom ratio.  
Using preset ratios  
Press [Zoom].  
1
2
Select the following preset ratio.  
• 50%: Min.  
• 64%: Letter (8.5"  
×
11")  
Half-letter (5.5" × 8.5")  
• 78%: Legal (8.5"  
• 100%  
×
14")  
Letter (8.5" × 11")  
• 121% : Legal (8.5" × 14")  
• 129% : Letter (8.5" × 11")  
11" × 17"  
11" × 17"  
• 154% : Half-letter (5.5" × 8.5")  
Legal (8.5" × 14")  
For enlargement copy, you can only use the document glass.  
Press [Enter].  
NOTE:  
3
Adjusting the ratio 1% increments  
Press [Zoom].  
1
Adjust the ratio by using [ + ] or [ - ].  
2
(You can set the magnification from 25 to 100% for the ADF, from 25 to 400%  
for the document glass.)  
Press [Enter].  
3
Manually enter the ratio  
Press [Zoom].  
1
Use the numeric keys to enter your desired ratio.  
(You can set the magnification from 25 to 100% for the ADF, from 25 to 400%  
for the document glass.)  
2
Press [Enter].  
3
7-12 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic sorting  
Copy jobs can be collated into indivdual sets, meaning they are ready for office  
distribution.  
To enable/disable automatic sorting:  
[ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [Sort].  
1
2
3
4
5
6
You can change the default setting for [Sort]. See “Accessing the copy settings”  
on page 12-3.  
NOTE:  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
COPYING 7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Combine  
Multiple originals can be copied into an arrangement on one sheet of paper.  
Document orientation on the ADF  
or document glass  
Result image of combined copy  
• In case of 2-in-1  
• In case of 4-in-1  
NOTE: • For enlargement copy, you can only use the document glass.  
• This machine does not have an image rotation function.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [COPY] to display the Copy standby mode.  
2
Press [Others], [Combine].  
3
NOTE: You can assign [Combine] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on pages 10-2 to 10-6.  
Select the number of document to be combined on to one sheet of paper.  
4
• When you set an advanced function, proceed to step 5.  
• When you do not set an advanced function, proceed to step 8.  
Press [Advance].  
5
7-14 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting the paper  
(1) When selecting the paper, press [Paper].  
6
(2) Select the paper.  
1
2
3
4
(3) Press [Enter].  
5
Setting the magnification  
6
The magnification is automatically set. However you can change the copy magnifi-  
cation in the following steps.  
7
(1) Press [Ratio] to change the copy magnification.  
7
(2) Select a preset ratio, use [ + ] [ - ] or the numeric keys to set the magnifica-  
tion.  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• The magnification can be set from 25% to 100% for the ADF, from 25% to  
400% for the document glass.  
(3) Press [Enter].  
Press [Enter] twice to return to the standby mode.  
8
Set the document and press [Start].  
9
Press [Reset] to cancel the combine copy settings.  
NOTE:  
COPYING 7-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Duplex copy  
You can use this function to perform:  
• One-sided copying of a duplex document (2:1) (See page 7-19)  
• Duplex copying of a duplex document (2:2)* (See page 7-21)  
• Duplex copying of a one-sided document (1:2)* (See page 7-23)  
* The duplex printing unit is required.  
Binding  
position  
Result image of  
duplexed copy  
Document orientation  
2
R&L*1  
Top*1  
2
2
1 sided  
1
1
R&L*1  
Top*1  
1
1
1
1
1
1
*1 The front and backside of the document must be in the same direction.  
7-16 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Binding  
position  
Result image of  
duplexed copy  
Document orientation  
• When you place • When you place  
the front side  
the backside  
2
R&L*2  
2
1
1
2
2
2
Top*1  
3
2
2 sided  
1
1
4
R&L*1  
1
1
5
• When you place • When you place  
the front side  
the backside  
6
1
2
Top*2  
1
1
2
7
1
8
2
R&L  
Top  
9
2
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
1
2 sided  
1
1
1
1
R&L  
Top  
1
1
*1 The front and backside of the document must be in the same direction.  
*2 The front side and the backside are set in different directions.  
NOTE: • Enlargement copy is only available when you perform the duplex copy (1:2) of  
one-sided documents using the document glass.  
• This machine does not have an image rotation function.  
COPYING 7-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to bind copied documents  
The document can be bound on the left side, right side or top.  
Right or left binding  
Document  
Left binding  
Right binding  
• Select these when binding on the right or left side of the copy.  
Top binding  
Top binding  
Document  
• Select this when binding on the top side of the copy.  
7-18 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
One-sided copying of a duplex document (2:1)  
This mode allows you to convert two-sided originals into one-sided documents.  
1
Scan the front side.  
2
Turn over the document  
and scan the backside.  
3
The scanned data temporarily  
saved in the memory will be  
sorted and printed.  
1
2
To ADF  
3
To ADF  
When the power fails due to such as blackout during one-sided copying of  
duplex document, see as follows:  
NOTE:  
4
• While sorting the scanned data:  
5
The scanned data temporarily saved will not be saved in memory.  
• When sorting the scanned data is completed:  
The scanned data temporarily saved will be saved in memory.  
6
Set the front side of the duplex document in the ADF.  
Press [COPY] to display the Copy standby mode.  
1
2
3
7
8
Press [Others], [DuplexCopy]*.  
* If the duplex printing unit is not installed, press [DuplexScan].  
9
NOTE: You can assign [DuplexCopy] (or [DuplexScan]) to the soft key. See “Soft keys”  
on pages 10-2 to 10-6.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [2 -> 1 sided]*.  
* If the duplex printing unit is not installed, press [ON].  
4
• If you set an advanced functions proceed to step 5.  
• If you do not set an advanced function, proceed to step 7.  
Press [Advance].  
5
COPYING 7-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Press [Bind] to set the document bind position.  
6
• Press [DuplexCopy]* to return to the duplex copy display.  
* Not displayed if the duplex printing unit is not installed.  
(2) Press [Right&Left] or [Top].  
(3) Press [Enter].  
Press [Enter] twice to return to the standby display.  
Press [Reset] to cancel the duplex copy settings.  
7
8
9
Press [Start].  
The front side of the duplex document will be scanned.  
When the following display is shown, place the backside of the duplex docu-  
ment in the same direction as the front side and press [Start].  
• Press [Stop] to cancel.  
• Be sure to set the document in the correct direction. (See the table on page  
7-16.)  
7-20 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Duplex copying of a duplex document (2:2)  
This mode will convert two-sided originals into two-sided documents.  
* The duplex printing unit is required.  
Set the front side of the duplex document in the ADF.  
1
Press [Copy] to display the Copy standby mode.  
2
1
Press [Others], [DuplexCopy].  
3
2
NOTE: You can assign [DuplexCopy] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on pages 10-2 to  
10-6.  
3
Press [2 -> 2 sided].  
4
4
5
6
7
8
• If you set an advanced function, proceed to step 5.  
• If you do not set an advanced function, proceed to step 7.  
9
Press [Advance].  
5
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(1) Press [Bind] to set document bind position.  
6
• Press [DuplexCopy] to return to the duplex copy display.  
COPYING 7-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(2) Press [Right&Left] or [Top].  
(3) Press [Enter].  
Press [Enter] twice to return to the standby mode.  
Press [Reset] to cancel the duplex copy settings.  
7
8
9
Press [Start].  
Scan the front side of the duplex document.  
When the following display is shown, set the document in the correct direction  
and press [Start]. (See the table on page 7-17.)  
• Press [Stop] to cancel.  
• Be sure to set the document in the correct direction. (See the table on page  
7-17.)  
7-22 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Duplex copying of a one-sided document (1:2)  
* The duplex printing unit is required.  
Set the document.  
1
Press [COPY] to display the Copy standby mode.  
2
Press [Others], [DuplexCopy].  
3
1
NOTE: You can assign [DuplexCopy] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on pages 10-2 to  
10-6.  
2
Press [1 -> 2 sided].  
4
3
4
5
6
7
8
• If you set an advanced function, proceed to step 5.  
• If you do not set an advanced function, proceed to step 7.  
9
Press [Advance].  
5
(1) Press [Bind] to set the binding position.  
6
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• Press [DuplexCopy] to return to the duplex copy display.  
COPYING 7-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(2) Press [Right&Left] or [Top].  
(3) Press [Enter].  
Press [Enter] twice to return to the standby mode.  
Press [Reset] to cancel the duplex copy settings.  
7
Press [Start].  
8
9
Press [Yes] while the document is being scanned.  
Selecting [No] will cause one-sided document output.  
After the document has been scanned, set the next document.  
10  
11  
Press [Next Doc].  
• The Next Doc setting can be deleted by pressing [Complete].  
• To scan another document, press [Yes] while the document is being scanned.  
7-24 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Card Copy  
The front and back of an id card or check-sized original can be copied onto one sheet  
of paper by using the document glass. Two id card-sized originals can be also copied  
at the same time.  
When copied onto  
paper  
When copied onto  
paper  
Document orientation  
1
2
Card  
3
4
Card × 2  
5
6
Personal  
Check  
7
8
Business  
Check  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
• Copying can be done with the platen cover open. Avoid looking at the light  
while copying. Looking at the light could cause eye damage.  
• Card Copy is available only from the document. This function is not available  
for F-560/F-520.  
NOTE:  
Set the card or check on the document glass.  
1
2
(1) Press [Copy] to display the copy standby mode.  
(2) Press [Card Copy].  
COPYING 7-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Select the type of object you want to copy.  
(2) Press [Advance].  
3
(1) Press [Paper] to select the paper.  
You can change the type of object by pressing [Card Copy].  
4
(2) Press [Enter] twice.  
Press [Start].  
5
6
Once scanning has completed, turn over all of the placed originals and press  
[Next Doc].  
• The Next Doc setting can be deleted by pressing [Complete].  
7-26 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifying the document size to copy  
If the document size exceeds the size set, only the default scan range will be copied.  
To insure that your job is scanned properly, please adjust the scan range.  
Set the document.  
1
(1) Press [COPY] to display the Copy standby mode.  
2
1
(2) Press [Others].  
2
Press [Doc.Size].  
3
3
NOTE: You can assign [Doc.Size] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on pages 10-2 to 10-6.  
(1) Select the size of the document to be copied.  
4
4
5
6
7
8
9
(2) Press [Enter] twice.  
Press [Start].  
5
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
COPYING 7-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking the copy print queue  
If a job is scanned while another job is printing, that job will be reserved in the copy  
print queue.  
The copy will be printed based on the order in which it was scanned.  
In addition, if the toner or paper runs out while copying, copy reservation can be  
used in the same way if the job has not been completed.  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Display Jobs in Queue].  
1
Press [Reserved Copy].  
2
This shows the jobs currently in the queue.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
3
7-28 COPYING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
8
PC-Fax function  
Installing the driver...............................................................................8-2  
Sending a PC fax....................................................................................8-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
You can send a document from a PC application to a remote fax machine or e-mail  
location:  
This process allows you to save time and reduce the paper consumption in your  
office.  
Installing the driver  
In order to perform a PC fax, you need to have the PC-FAX driver installed on your  
PC.  
The PC-FAX driver is located on the CD supplied with your machine. For more  
information on how to install the driver, refer to the “Network Printer Manual”  
located on the CD.  
8-2  
PC-FAX FUNCTION  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a PC fax  
After the PC-FAX driver is installed on your PC, you can send a document directly  
from your PC to a remote fax machine or e-mail inbox.  
The following steps provide the basic procedure for sending a PC fax.  
Verify that your machine is properly connected to the computer and the power  
has been turned on.  
1
1
Verify that you have installed the fax driver on your computer.  
2
2
Start the desired application program and create/open a document.  
3
3
Click [Print] from the File menu.  
4
Make sure that “Muratec  
Fax” is selected as the printer. ( indicates your  
***  
***  
machine’s model name, ex.“Muratec F-520 FAX”.)  
4
If you want to make any adjustments, click [Properties]. For details, refer to the  
“Network Printer Manual” on the CD supplied with your machine.  
5
Click [Print].  
5
6
The “Fax Transmission Settings” dialog will appear.  
7
NOTE: To display the “Fax Transmission Settings”, a Web browser such as Microsoft  
Internet Explorer should be installed on your computer.  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
A
Specify the destination and click [Send].  
6
NOTE: For more information on PC faxing, refer to the “Network Printer Manual” on  
the CD supplied with your machine.  
PC-FAX FUNCTION  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8-3  
8-4  
PC-FAX FUNCTION  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
9
PC printing  
Installing the driver...............................................................................9-2  
Printing a document from the PC.........................................................9-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Your machine can be used as a printer, either locally through the USB port or  
through the network via the Ethernet port.  
PHO  
NE1  
PHO  
NE2  
LIN  
E
PHO  
NE1  
PHO  
NE2  
LIN  
E
Installing the driver  
In order to use your machine as a local or network printer you should have the  
applicable print driver installed on your PC.  
The drivers are located on the CD supplied with your machine. The CD also con-  
tains “Local Printer and Scanner Manual” and “Network Printer Manual”, please  
refer to these guides for the installation instructions.  
9-2  
PC PRINTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing a document from the PC  
After the network or local print driver is installed on your PC, you can printout  
documents from virtually any PC application.  
The following steps describe the typical process when printing documents out of  
Windows-based applications. The exact process may vary depending on the applica-  
tion you are using.  
1
Verify that your machine is properly connected to the computer, the power has  
been turned on and the cassette is full of paper.  
1
9
Verify that you have installed the print driver on your computer.  
2
3
Start the desired application program and create/open a document.  
3
4
Click [Print] or [Print Setup] from the File menu.  
4
Make sure that “Muratec  
” is selected as the printer. ( indicates your  
***  
***  
machine’s model name, ex.“Muratec F-520”.)  
5
If you want to make any adjustments, click [Properties] or [Setup].  
6
Click [OK] or [Print] to start the print job.  
5
7
NOTE: For more information on printing, refer to the “Local Printer and Scanner  
Manual” and “Network Printer Manual” on the CD supplied with your machine.  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
A
PC PRINTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9-3  
9-4  
PC PRINTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
10  
Special features  
Soft keys ...............................................................................................10-2  
Soft key functions .........................................................................10-2  
Programming a soft key ...............................................................10-5  
Macro keys............................................................................................10-7  
Registering or editing a Macro.....................................................10-7  
Deleting a Macro key..................................................................10-10  
Changing the Macro key speed..................................................10-11  
Editing macro key titles .............................................................10-12  
Executing a Macro command.....................................................10-13  
Program one-touch.............................................................................10-14  
Registering or editing a program one-touch..............................10-14  
Deleting a program one-touch....................................................10-19  
How to use a program one-touch ...............................................10-20  
F-code box feature..............................................................................10-21  
F-code introduction.....................................................................10-21  
Registering or editing an F-code box .........................................10-21  
Printing a list of F-code boxes....................................................10-30  
Printing a list of documents stored in F-code boxes .................10-30  
Deleting an empty F-code box....................................................10-30  
Storing a document in a bulletin box.........................................10-31  
Printing stored documents ........................................................10-33  
Deleting stored documents.........................................................10-35  
Sending a document using a subaddress and password...........10-37  
Polling a document using a subaddress and password.............10-38  
Viewing the page counters.................................................................10-39  
Checking the number of printed pages .....................................10-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Soft keys  
The soft key is a shortcut key. By assigning frequently used functions to a soft key  
you can perform instant recall of this feature. The five soft keys can be displayed on  
the standby mode.  
You can program the soft keys for the copy, fax and scanner displays. Also, the fax  
and scanner displays have multiple tabs on the bottom of the display that toggle  
between fax, e-mail, folder etc. Each of these tabs can contain its own set of soft  
keys.  
Example of Copy standby mode  
Soft key 1  
Soft key 2  
Soft key 3  
Soft key 4  
Soft key 5  
Soft key functions  
The following table lists the functions you can assign to a soft key.  
Copy mode  
Function name  
Descriptions  
Use this to perform the macro program.  
Use this to set the document type and resolution for copying.  
Use this to set the contrast for copying.  
Use this to set the card copy.  
Reference page  
p.10-7  
p.7-8  
Macro Program  
Doc.Type  
Contrast  
Card Copy *1  
Zoom  
p.7-9  
p.7-25  
p.7-12  
p.7-13  
p.7-14  
p.7-16  
p.7-27  
p.7-11  
Use this to set the magnification for copying.  
Makes on/off setting for sort copy.  
Sort  
Combine  
Duplex Copy *2  
Doc. Size  
Bypass  
Use this to set the combine copy.  
Use this to set the duplex copy.  
Use this to select the size of the document to be copied.  
Use this to set the paper type on the bypass tray.  
*1 : This function is for MFX-2030/MFX-1430 only.  
*2 : The duplex printing unit is required. When the duplex printing unit is not installed, [DuplexScan] will be  
displayed.  
10-2 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax/I-Fax mode  
Each tab can have the same set of soft keys or you can customize each tab’s soft  
keys.  
Function name  
Descriptions  
Fax  
Internet fax  
Reference page  
p.10-7  
p.3-2  
Macro Program  
Resolution*  
Contrast*  
Use this to perform the macro program.  
Use this to set the scanning resolution.  
Use this to set the scanning contrast.  
Use this to specify the destination to redial.  
Use this to obtain a dial tone for on-hook dialing.  
1
p.3-3  
Redial  
p.3-13  
p.2-19  
p.2-12  
Monitor  
2
Address Book  
Use this to specify the destination by the address book  
number.  
3
Fax Forward  
Fax & Copy  
Makes on/off setting for fax forwarding.  
Makes on/off setting for Fax&Copy.  
p.3-51  
p.3-28  
p.10-20  
p.2-16  
p.11-5  
p.3-31  
p.3-30  
p.3-32  
p.13-8  
4
Program One-Touch Use this to perform program one-touch.  
Group Tx  
Security Rx  
TTI*  
Use this to make a group transmission.  
Makes on/off setting for security reception.  
Makes on/off setting for TTI sending.  
Select the TTI to be sent.  
5
TTI Select*  
Cover Page*  
Tx Report*  
6
Makes on/off setting for cover page.  
Makes on/off setting for print the transmit confirma-  
tion report.  
7
Delayed Tx  
Batch Tx  
Use this to make a delayed transmission.  
Use this to store a ducument for batch transmission.  
Use this to specify the scanning size for documents.  
Use this to make a polling reception.  
p.3-34  
p.3-35  
p.3-41  
p.3-50  
p.10-38  
p.10-37  
p.3-43  
p.3-5  
8
Scan Size*  
Polling  
9
FPolling  
Use this to make a F-code polling.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
F-Code Tx  
Overseas Tx*  
Memory Tx*  
Dialing Options  
Broadcast  
Mail Address  
Use this to make a F-code transmission.  
Makes on/off setting for overseas transmission.  
Makes on/off setting for memory transmission.  
Use this to enter a dialing character.  
p.3-45  
p.3-24  
p.4-2  
Use this to make a broadcasting.  
Use this when manually entering e-mail address for  
sending.  
Mail History  
Displays the history of e-mail address manually  
entered using QWERTY keypad.  
p.4-4  
Re-mail  
Displays the e-mail address to which you sent last.  
p.4-3  
p.4-7  
e-mail Subject*  
Enable to edit a subject line and a message attached to  
e-mail, if necessary.  
Batch Scan*  
Check Mail  
File Format*  
Makes on/off setting for batch scan.  
p.4-11  
p.4-12  
p.4-13  
Use this to check new arriving e-mail immediately.  
Use this to select the attachment format.  
(: possible to setup.)  
* These functions are only valid for the next transmission. Once that transmission  
is complete, the setting will return to its default setting. If you want to change the  
default setting, see “Fax settings” on page 12-4.  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan mode  
Each scan mode can have the same set of soft keys or you can customize each tab’s  
soft keys.  
Function name  
Descriptions  
e-mail Folder FTP Reference page  
Macro Program  
Doc. Type  
Contrast  
Resolution  
Zoom  
Use this to ender, edit or perform a macro program.  
Use this to set the document type for scanning.  
Use this to set the contrast for scanning.  
Use this to set the scanning resolution.  
Use this to set the magnification for scanning.  
Use this to specify the scanning size for documents.  
Use this to make a broadcast.  
p.10-7  
p.5-4  
p.5-3  
p.5-2  
p.5-57  
p.5-5  
Scan Size  
Broadcast  
Color  
p.5-63  
p.5-56  
Use this key to toggle the monochrome and color scan  
mode.  
Duplex Scan  
Batch Scan  
Use this to scan a two-sided document.  
p.5-61  
p.5-59  
Use this to select the scanned pages saved as one file  
or individual.  
File Format  
Use this to select the file format for the scanned docu-  
ment.  
p.5-60  
Mail Address  
Attachment  
Use this when entering e-mail addresses manually.  
p.5-9  
Enables additional files attached to the scanned docu-  
ment and send.  
p.5-64  
File Name  
Enables to add a file name to the scanned document.  
p.5-6  
Address Book  
Use this to specify the destination by the address book  
number.  
p.2-12  
e-mail Subject  
Mail History  
Re-mail  
Enables to edit a subject line and a message attached  
to e-mail.  
p.5-24  
p.5-21  
p.5-22  
Displays the last 20 manually entered e-mail  
addresses.  
Displays the last e-mail address you sent to.  
(: possible to setup.)  
10-4 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Programming a soft key  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Soft Key].  
1
2
3
1
2
3
4
Select the standby mode.  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
The machine shows the function currently assigned to the soft key.  
Select the soft key you want to change.  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Select the function you want to assign to a soft key.  
4
(2) Press [Enter].  
The selected function is assigned to the corresponding soft key.  
If you want to program another soft key, repeat the procedures from step 3.  
To exit the operation, press [Reset].  
5
NOTE: If a function is already set as a soft key, you cannot register that function into  
another soft key.  
10-6 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Macro keys  
If you perform the same operation repeatedly, you can automate the operation  
using a macro. A macro is a series of the several steps grouped together as a single  
command to accomplish the operation automatically.  
A macro key can record up to 60 steps.  
1
• Press [Reset] first when you use other functions within a few minutes after  
executing Macro.  
NOTE:  
• When you set the copy protect to [ON], you cannot use the macro program.  
You can execute [Macro Program] from all mode of Copy, Fax and Scan by  
pressing [Macro Program] (See page 10-13).  
2
3
You can assign [Macro Program] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
4
Registering or editing a Macro  
In any standby mode, press [Others], [Macro Program].  
1
5
When steps have already been registered in Macros, the corresponding list of  
steps for that key will be displayed. In that case, press [Enter].  
NOTE:  
6
Press [Enter/Edit].  
2
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Select the macro key you want to register.  
4
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Yes] to enter or edit a macro key.  
• If you want to cancel, press [No] and go back to step 4.  
5
Perform the operation you want to register.  
6
• During the programming, the machine beeps to indecate the machine is in  
the macro programming mode.  
NOTE:  
You can register up to 60 steps. When you exceed 60 steps.  
“Too many commands. Would you like to enter?” message will appear.  
If you want to register them, press [Yes].  
If you want to abort, press [No].  
• While the registering, any mistakes in the operations and changes procedures  
are also registered.  
• Normally, the key to finish the macro registration is [Start]. However, when  
you select the operation including browsing the folders or files on network or  
seaching directory as below, the key to execute the browsing operation or to  
execute searching directory is used to finish the registration.  
The last key in the following steps becomes the key to finish the registration.  
• [SCAN], [e-mail], [Search], ([Advanced]), (Condition entry), [Execute]  
• [SCAN], [e-mail], [Others], [Attachment]  
• [SCAN], [Folder], [Browse]  
• [SCAN], [Folder], [Add/Edit], (Number selection), [Link]  
• [SCAN], [Folder], [Others], [Attachment]  
• [SCAN], [FTP], [Others], [Attachment]  
• [Setting], [Scanner Settings], [Folder Shortcut], [Add/Edit], (Number selec-  
tion), [Link]  
Press [Start] to finish the entry.  
7
10-8 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following display will appear when you press [Start].  
NOTE:  
1
2
Press [Yes] to register the operation including the [Start] command.  
Press [No] to register the operation but exclude the [Start] command.  
3
You can use this function as follows:  
Press [No] while registering the sending operation to exclude [Start] in the  
Macro command. When the Macro command is selected, all the registered steps  
will run but you will need to manually select [Start] to begin job execution. This  
allows you to perform other setting adjustments in addition to the Macro com-  
mands.  
4
5
* If you press [Yes] and include [Start] in the Macro command, the fax and  
Internet fax will be sent. Therefore, such settings as delayed transmissions  
cannot be set.  
6
7
Enter the title.  
• The title can contain up to 60 characters.  
• For details on character entry, see page 1-10.  
8
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Press [Enter] to complete the entry.  
9
• Individual operations cannot be changed once registered. You will need to  
return to the beginning and perform the entire entry again.  
NOTE:  
• To print a list of macro keys, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Macro  
List], then [Yes].  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting a Macro key  
In any standby mode, press [Others], [Macro Program], [Enter].  
1
2
Press [Delete].  
Select the macro key you want to delete.  
3
Press [Yes] to delete.  
• If you want to cancel, press [No].  
4
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
5
10-10 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing the Macro key speed  
You can adjust the Macro key speed.  
The default setting is “Normal”.  
In any standby mode, press [Other], [Macro Program], [Enter].  
1
2
If nothing is registered in “Macro No.”, you cannot change this setting.  
1
Press [Key Speed].  
2
3
4
5
6
Select the key speed, and then press [Enter].  
4
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
5
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing macro key titles  
The Macro key titles can be edited.  
In any standby mode, press [Others], [Macro Program], [Enter].  
1
2
3
4
Press [Edit Title].  
Select the macro key whose title you want to edit.  
Edit the macro name as you want.  
• The title can contain up to 60 characters.  
(For details on character entry, refer to page 1-10.)  
Press [Enter] to save the title.  
5
6
To edit another title, repeat from step 3.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
10-12 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Executing a Macro command  
In any standby mode, press [Others], [Macro Program].  
1
2
Press the macro key you want to run.  
If you want to stop the macro operation in progress, press [Stop].  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Program one-touch  
By registering advanced communications in a program one-touch, you can perform  
a multi-step operation by simply pressing one key.  
You can register the following functions:  
• Delayed transmission  
• Polling  
• F-code polling  
• F-code transmission  
Delayed transmissions can be combined with any of the other three operations.  
Registering or editing a program one-touch  
This describes the procedure for registering a fax number or advanced communica-  
tion into a programmable one-touch. You can edit the number or name by overwrit-  
ing or deleting the existing information in each step.  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Program One-Touch], [Enter/Edit].  
1
2
Press the program one-touch number you want to register or edit.  
Specify the destination. You can specify multiple destinations.  
• Press [Dialing Options], then enter the number using the numeric keys.  
– or –  
3
• Specify the destination using the address book.  
– or –  
• Press [Address Book Entry], then specify the address book number.  
– or –  
• Press [Group Tx], then specify a group.  
10-14 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Others].  
4
5
Select the advanced communication.  
1
2
3
4
• If you press [Delayed Tx], go to step 6 of the “Delayed transmissions” on page  
10-15.  
• If you press [Polling], go to step 6 of the “Polling reception” on page 10-16.  
• If you press [FPolling], go to step 6 of the “F-code polling” on page 10-18.  
• If you press [F-Code Tx], go to step 6 of the “F-code transmission” on page 10-  
17.  
5
6
7
Delayed transmissions  
Delayed transmissions can be combined with any of the other three operations.  
8
Use [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ]or the numeric keys to register the transmission time.  
• If “00” is set for the day, the communication will start on the day set for the  
programmable one-touch.  
6
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Press [Enter] to return to the display in step 5 on page 10-15.  
7
When combining this operation with another operation, proceed to register the  
next operation.  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When you finished the registrastion, press [Enter].  
8
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
Polling reception  
Press [ON].  
6
Press [Enter] to return to the display in step 5.  
• If performing a delayed transmission, press [Delayed Tx] and proceed to step  
6 of “Delayed transmissions”. (See page 10-15.)  
7
Press [Enter] to complete the entry.  
8
9
Press [Enter] again to finish the registration.  
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
10-16 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-code transmission  
Use the numeric keys to enter the sub-address.  
• The sub-address can contain up to 20 characters, * and/or #.  
6
1
2
3
4
Press [Enter].  
7
8
5
Use the numeric keys to enter the password.  
• The password can contain up to 20 characters, * and/or #.  
• If the remote machine’s F-code Box has not been set a passcode, do not enter  
any character.  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Press [Enter] to return to the display in step 4.  
• When performing a delayed transmission, press [Delayed Tx] and proceed to  
step 6 of “Delayed transmissions”. (See page 10-15.)  
9
Press [Enter] to complete the entry.  
10  
11  
Press [Enter] again to finish the registration.  
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-code polling  
Use the numeric keys to enter the sub-address number.  
• The sub-address can contain up to 20 characters, * and/or #.  
6
Press [Enter].  
7
8
Use the numeric keys to enter the password.  
• The password can contain up to 20 characters, * and/or #.  
Press [Enter] to return to the display in step 5.  
• When performing a delayed transmission, press [Delayed Tx] and proceed to  
step 6 of “Delayed transmissions”. (See page 10-15.)  
9
Press [Enter] to complete the entry.  
10  
11  
Press [Enter] again to finish the registration.  
To return to the standby mode, press [Reset].  
10-18 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting a program one-touch  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Program One-Touch], [Delate].  
1
2
3
Press the program one-touch number you want to delete.  
When the confirmation message appears, press [Yes] to delete.  
• Press [No] to cancel the deletion.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
To delete another program one-touch number, repeat from step 2.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
7
To print a list of program one-touch numbers, press [Setting], [List], [Other  
lists], [Program One-Touch], then [Yes].  
NOTE:  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to use a program one-touch  
Example: When delayed transmission has been registered.  
Set the document (See page 1-25).  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Press [Others].  
3
Press [Program One-Touch].  
4
You can assign [Program One-Touch] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page  
10-2.  
NOTE:  
Select the program one-touch you want to execute.  
5
When the confirmation message appears, press [Yes] to execute it.  
6
10-20 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
F-code box feature  
F-code introduction  
The ITU-T, the United Nations agency that standardizes international telecom-  
munications, has created the fax industry standard for using subaddressing and  
password-based communication.  
With subaddressing, your machine can perform secure transmissions and polling.  
1
Another term for subaddressing is F-code, which Muratec uses on the machine  
display and in the instruction manual.  
2
Guidelines for using F-code  
3
(1) Before creating an F-code box, you must know if the remote fax machine is com-  
patible with the ITU-T subaddressing protocol and that this feature is active on  
the machine.  
4
(2) To permit the other party to send or poll documents from your F-code boxes,  
you must create an F-code box in your machine and the other party must know  
your F-code box’s subaddress and password.  
5
(3) To send or poll the remote fax machine’s F-code boxes, you have to know their  
6
subaddress and password.  
7
Registering or editing an F-code box  
8
The elements of creating an F-code box are as follows:  
Box Name  
You can assign an identifier name for each F-code box.  
(The name can contain up to 16 characters.)  
9
Sub-address  
This is the ITU-T subaddress needed to perform an F-code fax transac-  
tion. (A subaddress and password can contain up to 20 characters and  
may consist of numbers, * or #.)  
The subaddress and password (if set) sent from remote fax machine  
must match with your F-code box’s subaddress (and password) for F-  
code communication to be possible.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Password  
This is the password for ITU-T subaddressing.  
Assigning a password is optional, but using a password will make your  
F-code communication more secure.  
Box feature  
You can set up an F-code box as a bulletin box or a security reception  
box.  
Bulletin box — Holds scanned or received documents in memory and  
waits for a polling request from another F-code compatible fax machine.  
Security box — Documents received in the security box are held for  
a predetermined (by user) time period and are not printed automati-  
cally. You will need to enter an I.D. code to print them.  
I.D. code  
This 4-digit I.D. code protects the F-code box settings from unauthor-  
ized access. Assigning an I.D. code is optional for the bulletin box, but  
required for the security box.  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering or editing an F-code box  
NOTE: If you want to change an existing F-code box, you first must delete the old box  
before creating a new one.  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [F-Code Box], [Enter/Edit].  
1
Select the F-code box you want to register.  
2
Select the type of F-code box.  
3
Refer to pages 10-23 through 10-29 for the registration method.  
4
10-22 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you setup a Security box  
Press [Secure Box].  
5
Use the numeric keys to enter the sub-address. This is the numerical identifier  
you must enter in order to communicate with any remote F-code compatible  
fax.  
6
• Up to 20 digits can be entered for sub-addresses. Numerals, #, * can be  
entered.  
• If the number is incorrect, press [Clear] to erase it, then re-enter the number  
correctly.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Press [Enter].  
7
8
8
Use the numeric keys to enter the I.D. code (4 digits).  
• The I.D. code is required to retrieve documents in the security box, or to edit  
the box settings.  
• The I.D. code cannot be viewed after it is entered, be sure to remember this  
code.  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Press [Enter].  
9
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the box name.  
(1) Press [Box Name].  
10  
(2) Enter the box name.  
• The name can contain up to 16 characters.  
• For details on character entry, see “Entering characters”on page 1-10.  
(3) Press [Enter].  
Enter the ITU-T password and hold time as necessary.  
11  
10-24 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering a password  
(1) Press [Password].  
(2) Enter the password using the numeric keys, then press [Enter].  
• Up to 20 digits can be entered for passwords. Numerals, # and * can be  
entered.  
• This is the password for ITU-T-compatible F-Code fax transactions. You do  
not need to have a password for the F-Code box. However, using a password  
will make your F-Code communications more secure.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Setting the hold time  
The hold time is the period (0 to 31 days) for which documents in the security box  
are retained. Documents are retained indefinitely when 00 days has been set.  
8
(1) Press [Hold time].  
(2) Enter the hold time using [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys, then press [Enter].  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
To register another F-code box, press [Enter], then repeat from step 2 of “Regis-  
tering or editing an F-code box” on page 10-22.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
12  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you setup a Bulletin box  
Press [Bulletin Box].  
5
Use the numeric keys to enter the sub-address. This is the numerical identifier  
you must enter in order to communicate with any remote F-code compatible  
fax.  
6
• Up to 20 digits can be entered for sub-addresses. Numerals, #, * can be  
entered.  
• If you enter an incorrect number, press [Clear] to delete it and then enter the  
correct one.  
Press [Enter].  
7
8
Enter the box name.  
(1) Press [Box Name].  
(2) Enter the box name.  
• The name can contain up to 16 characters.  
• For details on character entry, see page 1-10.  
(3) Press [Enter].  
Perform settings for Password, Rx Protect, Auto Print, OverWrite, Erase Tx  
Doc, and I.D.Code as necessary.  
9
10-26 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entering an ITU-T password  
(1) Press [Password].  
(2) Enter the password using the numeric keys, then press [Enter].  
• Up to 20 digits can be entered for passwords. Numerals, # and * can be  
entered.  
1
2
3
4
5
Setting protected reception  
6
(1) Press [Rx Protect].  
• When protected reception has been set to [ON], a document cannot be  
received into this bulletin box.  
7
(2) Select either [ON] or [OFF], then press [Enter].  
• If [ON] has been selected for this setting, Auto Print and OverWrite settings  
are set to [OFF] and cannot be set.  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting auto print  
(1) Press [Auto Print].  
• If [ON] has been selected for auto print, documents received in the bulletin  
box will be printed automatically when it is received.  
(2) Select either [ON] or [OFF], then press [Enter].  
Setting overwrite  
(1) Press [OverWrite].  
• If you set the overwrite function to [ON], newly received documents will over-  
write documents previously stored in memory.  
(2) Select either [ON] or [OFF], then press [Enter].  
10-28 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting deletion of documents after transmission  
(1) Press [Prev] or [Next], then press [Erase Tx Doc].  
• When Erase Tx Doc has been set to [ON], the machine erases the document  
from the box as soon as it sends it.  
(2) Select either [ON] or [OFF], then press [Enter].  
1
2
3
4
5
Entering an I.D. code  
6
(1) Press [I.D.Code].  
You do not always need to register the I.D. code. Once you register it, how-  
ever, entering the I.D. code is required in the following cases.  
• When editing the box settings  
• When storing documents in the box  
• When printing the document stored in the box  
• Once entered, the I.D. code cannot be viewed. Be sure to remember this code.  
7
8
9
• To release the I.D. code, first enter the current registered I.D. code and then  
enter “0000”.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
(2) Enter the I.D. code (4 digits) using the numeric keys, then press [Enter].  
• If you enter an incorrect character, press [Clear] to delete it and enter the  
correct character.  
To register another F-code box, press [Enter], then repeat from step 2 of “Regis-  
tering or editing an F-code box” on page 10-22.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
9
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing a list of F-code boxes  
To print a list of your F-code boxes, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [F-Code  
Box], then [Yes].  
Printing a list of documents stored in F-code boxes  
To print a list of documents stored in F-code boxes, press [Setting], [List], [Other  
Lists], [F-Code Doc.], then [Yes].  
Deleting an empty F-code box  
An F-code box must be empty in order to delete it. (If you select the F-code box  
which is not empty, the machine will beep. If this happens, print the documents in  
the box prior to deleting it.)  
To delete an empty F-code box:  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [F-Code Box], [Delete].  
1
Select the F-code box you want to delete.  
2
Use the numeric keys to enter the I.D. code (4 digits) if it has been set.  
3
If an I.D. code has not been set, proceed to step 4.  
Press [Yes] to delete.  
• Press [No] to cancel the deletion.  
4
To delete another F-code box, repeat from step 2.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
5
10-30 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storing a document in a bulletin box  
Each bulletin box can hold up to 30 documents.  
Set the document (See page 1-25).  
1
Press [Setting], [Store Doc Settings], [Store].  
2
1
2
3
4
5
Press [Bulletin Box Doc.].  
6
3
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Select the F-code box that you want to store the document in.  
4
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Use the numeric keys to enter the I.D. code (4 digits) if it has been set.  
Proceed to step 6 if an I.D. code has not been set.  
5
Select the document storage method.  
• Over Write  
6
Overwrites documents in the box.  
• Add  
Adds documents to the box.  
Press [Yes].  
7
10-32 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing stored documents  
You can print out documents in the security reception box, documents received in  
the bulletin boxes and documents stored in the bulletin boxes.  
If documents have been received into F-code boxes, the F-code reception informa-  
tion will be printed out. Use this information to locate and print the document.  
Press [Setting], [Store Doc Settings], [Print].  
1
1
Press [F-Code Doc.].  
2
2
3
4
5
6
7
Select the F-code box that contains the document.  
3
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Use the numeric keys to enter the I.D. code (4 digits) if it has been set.  
4
If an I.D. code has not been set, proceed to step 5.  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select the applicable file number.  
5
For security box reception, the procedure will end after step 5.  
Select “All stored documents.” to print out every document stored in this F-code  
box.  
Press [Yes].  
6
Any stored or received document will be printed.  
• Documents in the security reception box will be removed from memory after  
they have been printed.  
• Documents received or stored in bulletin boxes will not be deleted after they  
are printed.  
10-34 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting stored documents  
Press [Setting], [Store Doc Settings], [Delete], [Bulletin Box Doc.].  
1
1
2
3
4
Select the F-code box that contains the document(s) you want to delete.  
2
5
indicates that there are documents stored in the box.  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Use the numeric keys to enter the I.D. code (4 digits) if it has been set.  
3
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select the applicable file number.  
Select “All stored documents.” to delete every document stored in this file.  
4
Press [Yes] to delete.  
5
10-36 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a document using a subaddress and password  
Entering sub-addresses and passwords enables F-code security box transmissions  
and F-code bulletin box transmissions to be performed.  
First check the sub-address and password for each function registered on the  
remote machine.  
NOTE:  
1
Set the document (See page 1-25).  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Press [Others], [Next], [F-Code Tx].  
2
3
2
3
You can assign [F-Code Tx] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
NOTE:  
4
4
Use the numeric keys to enter the sub-address of the remote machine and then  
press [Enter].  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
Use the numeric keys to enter the password, and then press [Enter].  
• Up to 20 digits, consisting of numerals, * and/or # can be used for passwords.  
• If a password is not required, press [Enter] without entering anything and  
proceed to step 6.  
5
Press [Enter] to return to the standby mode.  
6
7
Specify the destination and begin the fax transmission.  
The numeric keys, address book and group dialing can be used.  
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polling a document using a subaddress and password  
Enter the sub-address and password to retrieve (polling) documents stored on a  
remote machine’s bulletin box.  
First check the bulletin box sub-address and password on the remote machine.  
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
NOTE:  
1
2
Press [Others], [Next], [FPolling].  
You can assign [FPolling] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
NOTE:  
3
Use the numeric keys to enter the sub-address of the bulletin box, then press  
[Enter].  
Use the numeric keys to enter the password, and then press [Enter].  
• Up to 20 digits, consisting of numerals, * and/or # can be used for passwords.  
4
• If a password is not required, press [Enter] without entering anything and  
proceed to step 5.  
Press [Enter] to return to the standby display.  
5
6
Specify the destination and begin polling.  
The numeric keys, address book and group dialing can be used.  
10-38 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing the page counters  
You can check the total number of pages printed on your machine. If duplex print-  
ing is used, each side of the document will count as one print. Meaning a two-sided  
document counts as 2 prints.  
Print Total  
Shows the total number of copies, fax receptions, lists and PC  
printouts made.  
1
Copy  
Shows the total number of copies printed.  
2
Fax/List  
Shows the total number of fax receptions and internet fax recep-  
tions and lists printed.  
3
PC Print  
Shows the total number of printouts.  
4
Scan Total  
Copy  
Shows the total number of scanned pages.  
Shows the total number of copy scans.  
5
Fax  
Shows the total number of fax scans and internet fax scans.  
Shows the total number of PC scans and scan to e-mail.  
PC Scan  
6
7
Checking the number of printed pages  
You can check the total number of pages printed and scanned on your machine.  
8
Press [Setting], [Counter].  
1
9
Select [Print Total] or [Scan Total].  
2
10  
11  
12  
13  
A
SPECIAL FEATURES 10-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The number of pages used for each function will be displayed.  
3
(When [Print Total] is selected)  
(When [Print Total] is selected)  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
10-40 SPECIAL FEATURES  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
11  
Restricting use of the machine  
Security features..................................................................................11-2  
Passcode protection.......................................................................11-2  
Security reception.........................................................................11-3  
PIN masking .................................................................................11-7  
Department management..................................................................11-13  
Registering the copy charge (Cost management)......................11-13  
Registering department codes....................................................11-14  
Deleting department codes.........................................................11-16  
Turning department management On...............................................11-17  
Using department codes.............................................................11-17  
Printing a list of department management settings.................11-19  
Resetting the department counter.............................................11-20  
Turning department management protection On/Off ..............11-21  
Copy protection ..................................................................................11-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Security features  
Your machine has a number of security features to keep your fax documents pri-  
vate, avoid unwanted outside communication and even protect against unauthor-  
ized machine usage.  
These security features include:  
(1) Security reception, (2) PIN masking, (3) Block junk fax, and (4) Department  
codes.  
Passcode protection  
Your machine has a passcode protection system that secures the following features:  
• Security reception  
• PIN masking  
• Department code protection  
To set the passcode:  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Protect Passcode].  
1
(1) Enter the four-digit number.  
2
To change or delete the protect passcode, enter the four-digit number  
already registered.  
(2) Press [Enter].  
The passcode has been registered.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
To change or delete the protect passcode, proceed to step 3.  
(1) To change the protect passcode, enter a new four-digit code.  
3
To delete the protect passcode, enter “0000”.  
(2) Press [Enter].  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
Write down the passcord, and put it in a safe place.  
NOTE:  
11-2 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Security reception  
Security reception tells your machine to keep all received faxes in memory (but not  
print them). You can print them out later at your convenience. This feature assists  
with HIPPA compliance.  
NOTE: To use this feature, you must activate the passcode protection feature as  
described on page 11-2.  
When protect passcode is [OFF], security reception will not be available.  
1
2
Activating security reception  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Security Reception].  
You need to register the protect passcode in advance. (See page 11-2)  
1
3
4
5
6
7
8
Use the numeric keys to enter the protect passcode, and then press [Enter].  
2
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(1) Select [ON] to activate security reception and [OFF] to deactivate it.  
3
(2) Press [Enter].  
If [ON] was selected in step 3, enter the start time.  
(1) Use [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the security reception  
start time.  
4
(2) Press [Enter].  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
5
11-4 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turning on security reception in real-time  
The machine will enter the security reception mode automatically at the prede-  
termined time. If you want to put the machine into the security reception mode in  
real-time, you can do this using the following procedure:  
NOTE: To enable the following procedure, the security reception feature must be  
active. (See “Activating security reception” above.)  
1
Real-time security reception:  
2
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
1
Press [Others], [SecurityRx].  
2
3
NOTE: You can assign [SecurityRx] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
4
(1) Use the numeric keys to enter the protect passcode.  
3
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
(2) Press [Enter].  
(1) Select either [ON] or [OFF].  
4
(2) Press [Enter].  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
5
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing documents stored in memory  
Press [Setting], [Store Doc Settings], [Print], [Security Rx Doc].  
1
2
Use the numeric keys to enter the protect passcode, and then press [Enter].  
Press [Yes] to print out documents received during security reception.  
3
Your machine will print all the documents received in the memory and then  
erase them from the memory. Then the machine turns the security reception  
off until the next time you have scheduled security reception.  
• If the reception box is empty, No document stored. Security Reception has  
been cancelled.” message will appear and the display will return to the  
standby mode.  
11-6 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PIN masking  
To prevent unauthorized long-distance calls, some PBX (private branch exchanger)  
systems require a PIN (personal identification number) entry when dialing a num-  
ber.  
Your machine’s PIN masking feature helps you keep that PIN number private. With  
PIN masking activated, you can dial a number plus a PIN, but the PIN will not  
appear in the journal, error message printout, delayed command list or TCR (trans-  
mit confirmation report). The PIN may contain up to eight characters including the  
* or # symbols. You can enter them from the numeric keys.  
1
2
There are three possible PIN masking settings:  
3
Off — Deactivates PIN masking. Any PIN you enter will appear on the display  
and/or printouts which show the number you dial.  
Mode 1 — Each remote fax machine has a PIN access code per department.  
Mode 2 — Each fax user has a PIN access code per department.  
4
5
NOTE: If you select either Mode 1 or Mode 2 and will be using the batch transmission  
feature, you must store the PIN access code within the appropriate batch box.  
6
Activating the PIN mask  
7
NOTE: To use this feature, passcode protection must be active. (See page 11-2.)  
8
Press [Setting], [Management], [Prev], [PIN Mode].  
1
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Use the numeric keys to enter the protect passcode, and then press [Enter].  
2
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Select desired mode, and then press [Enter].  
Select [OFF] to deactivate the setting.  
3
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
Registering the address book (Mode 1)  
In Mode 1, you must register the PIN into the address book. Transmission will not  
be possible if a PIN number has not been registered. If Mode 2 has been set, this  
procedure is not neccessary.  
Register or edit an entry in the address book. (See page 2-4, if necessary.)  
1
During registration, press [PIN].  
2
Use the numeric keys to enter the desired PIN, up to eight characters in length.  
3
Press [Enter] to save the PIN.  
4
Press [Enter] to save the address book setting.  
5
11-8 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• If you press [Enter] without entering the PIN, the machine will beep and  
display “The following data is required: PIN”, and then return to step 2.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
Registering program one-touch keys (Mode 1)  
In Mode 1, you must register a PIN to the program one-touch key. Transmission  
will not be possible if a PIN number has not been registered. If Mode 2 has been  
set, the following procedure is not neccessary.  
1
Registering or editing an entry using the program one-touch keys.  
(See page 10-14, if necessary.)  
1
2
Enter the phone number, then press the * (“star”) to enter the PIN.  
2
The PIN always follows the fax number.  
For example, to dial 98776544 with a PIN of “12345678”, enter  
98776544*12345678.  
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
– or –  
Use the address book and specify the number that contains the PIN number.  
(See “Registering the address book” on page 11-8.)  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
NOTE: You cannot specify the destination if a PIN has not been registered. For details  
on registering a PIN number in the address book, see “Registering the address  
book (Mode 1)” on page 11-8.  
Press [Enter] to save the number.  
• If you press [Enter] without entering the PIN, the machine will beep and  
display “The following data is required: PIN”, and then return to step 2.  
3
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
(1) Press [Others] and register the advanced communications.  
4
(2) Press [Enter] twice to save the settings.  
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dialing when using the PIN mask  
If you select Mode 1 - use the “star” method  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby mode.  
2
Specify the destination.  
3
If the destination was specified using the numeric keys, proceed to step 4.  
If the destination was specified using the address book, the transmission will  
begin.  
When you use the address book to specify a destination or multiple destina-  
tions, proceed to step 6.  
To register an address book for transmission, the PIN needs to be registered in  
advance.  
Enter the phone number, press * (“star”) and enter the PIN number.  
The PIN number always follows the fax number.  
For example, to dial 67778889 with a PIN of “12345678”, enter 67778889  
*12345678:  
4
Press [Enter].  
Press [Start].  
5
6
If you select Mode 2 - the display will show the proper procedure  
Set the document.  
1
Press [FAX] to display the Fax standby made.  
2
Specify the destination.  
3
If the destination was specified using the numeric keys and/or address book  
number, proceed to step 4.  
If you specify multiple destinations, proceed to step 4.  
If the destination was specified using the address book, proceed to step 5.  
Press [Start].  
4
11-10 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Use the numeric keys to enter the PIN number.  
Press [Reset] to cancel the settings.  
5
1
2
3
4
Press [Enter].  
6
Performing a batch transmission while using the PIN mask  
5
If you select either Mode 1 or Mode 2 and use Batch Transmission (See page 3-35),  
you must store the PIN access code for the remote machine within the appropriate  
batch box.  
6
Follow the steps for registering or editing a batch box. (See page 3-35)  
1
7
The display will ask for the fax number.  
Use the numeric keys to enter the fax number for the batch transmission.  
2
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
When using Mode 2, you cannot specify the destination using the address book.  
Even if the number you want to register in the batch transmission has been  
registered in the address book, use the numeric keys to enter the destination  
according to the procedure.  
NOTE:  
When using Mode 1, if the destination was specified using the address book,  
proceed to step 4.  
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter * (“star”) and enter the PIN number.  
3
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
4
Now you can perform a batch transmission with the PIN masking feature  
activated.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
11-12 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Department management  
When the department management setting is activated, the machine reminds each  
user to enter the department code before sending a document or making copies.  
With this feature, the fax transaction time and the copy charge can be managed by  
department.  
After this setting is turned on, assign a specific code to each user/department and  
the machine will require them to enter their department code prior to job execution.  
1
2
(1) Registering the copy charge per page. (See below.)  
3
(2) Registering department codes. (See page 11-14)  
4
(3) Turning department management on. (See page 11-17)  
5
(4) Using department codes. (See page 11-17)  
6
(5) Checking the operating conditions. (See page 11-19)  
7
Registering the copy charge (Cost management)  
Register a cost per page for copying.  
8
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Depart. Management].  
1
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Cost] to register the copy charge.  
2
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Use [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the cost per page.  
3
Press [Enter].  
4
5
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
Registering department codes  
You can register up to 100 department codes.  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Depart. Management], [Enter/Edit].  
1
2
Select the department code you want to register.  
• Press [001:] for the first entry.  
• To edit the name and number of a department already registered, select the  
number you want to edit.  
11-14 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enter the department code using [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys and then press  
[Enter].  
3
Up to 9 digits can be entered.  
1
2
3
4
Press [Department Name] to register the department name.  
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Enter the department name, and then press [Enter].  
• The department name can contain up to 20 characters. (For details on charac-  
ter entry, see page 1-10.)  
5
The list will be displayed and all registered data will appear.  
6
7
To register another department code, press [Enter] and repeat the procedures  
from step 2.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting department codes  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Depart. Management], [Delete].  
1
2
Select the department code you want to delete.  
Press [Yes] to delete.  
Press [No] to return to step 2 without deleting the number.  
3
To delete another department code, repeat the procedures from step 2.  
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
11-16 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turning department management On  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Depart. Management], [Setting].  
1
2
Press [Copy] to set the department management status for copying, and/or  
press [Fax] for faxing.  
[ON] and [OFF] will toggle each time you press the key. To use department  
management, set it to [ON].  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Using department codes  
To use this function, make sure:  
8
• The department code has been registered.  
• Each user/department knows their department code.  
9
Transmitting faxes  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Set the document (See page 1-25).  
Press [Fax] to display the Fax standby mode.  
Specify the destination.  
1
2
3
4
5
Press [Start].  
Use [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the department code.  
Press [Enter].  
Press [Reset] to reset the sending settings.  
6
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Making Copies  
Set the document (See page 1-25).  
1
2
3
Press [COPY] to display the Copy standby mode.  
Use [ ] [ ] or the numeric keys to enter the department code.  
If you press [Back], the department code entry display will disappear. Press  
[Start] to display it again.  
Press [Enter].  
4
5
Press [Start].  
If you continue to make copies, you do not need to enter the department code.  
If you select [Reset] and return to the standby mode, you will be asked to enter  
the department code again. If the machine is shared by multiple departments,  
select [Reset] after you have completed your job.  
11-18 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing a list of department management settings  
The department management list includes the following information for each  
department:  
• Copy charge ($/page)  
• Department code  
• Department name  
• Total communication time (in hours, minutes and seconds; h:mm:ss)  
Counts the communication time up to 999:59:59 (999 hours:59 minutes:59  
seconds). If the fax exceeds the maximum time, it will stop counting.  
1
2
• Total fax pages printed  
Counts the pages up to 999999 pages. If the fax count exceeds the maximum  
limit, it will stop counting.  
3
• Total pages copied  
Counts the pages up to 999999 pages. If the copy count exceeds the maximum  
limit, it will stop counting.  
4
• Total copy charge  
Counts the copy charge up to 99.99. If the copy charge exceeds the maximum  
charge, it will stop counting.  
5
6
NOTE: If you want to reset the counter, see “Resetting the department counter” on the  
next page.  
7
To print the list:  
8
Press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Department List], then [Yes]. The depart-  
ment list will be printed.  
9
NOTE: If the department management feature has been protected (See page 11-21),  
you cannot print the department list. You will have to deactivate the password  
protection feature in order to print.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Resetting the department counter  
To delete the current counts for department management  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Depart. Management].  
1
Press [Counter Reset].  
2
Press [Yes] to reset the counter for each department.  
Press [No] to return to step 2.  
3
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
11-20 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turning department management protection On/Off  
This feature protects the department management settings from unauthorized  
access. After you set it, you will have to enter the passcode to access the department  
management settings.  
This feature will work only if you have activated the passcord protection (See  
page 11-2.)  
NOTE:  
1
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Depart. Management], [Protect].  
Use the numeric keys to enter the passcode, and then press [Enter].  
1
2
2
3
4
5
6
7
Press [ON] to protect department management.  
• Press [OFF] to cancel the function.  
3
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
4
5
Press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copy protection  
Limit the use of your machine to send/receieve only, meaning the copy mode cannot  
be used:  
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Copy Protect].  
1
When the protect passcode is set, use the numeric keys to enter the protect  
passcode and press [Enter].  
2
When it has not been set, proceed to step 3.  
Press [ON] to activate copy protection.  
3
11-22 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press [Enter] to save the setting.  
4
If copy protection is active, whenever someone tries to switch the machine to  
the copy mode, the machine will beep and display “Copy protected”.  
When you set the copy protect to [ON], you cannot use the macro program.  
NOTE:  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE 11-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11-24 RESTRICTING USE OF THE MACHINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
12  
Machine Settings  
Machine setting menu .........................................................................12-2  
Copy settings........................................................................................12-3  
Accessing the copy settings ..........................................................12-3  
Fax settings ..........................................................................................12-4  
Accessing the default fax settings................................................12-4  
Accessing other fax settings.........................................................12-5  
Scanner settings...................................................................................12-7  
Accessing the default scan settings .............................................12-7  
Accessing other scan settings.......................................................12-8  
Mail settings.........................................................................................12-9  
Accessing the mail settings..........................................................12-9  
Management settings ........................................................................12-11  
Accessing the management settings..........................................12-11  
Paper settings.....................................................................................12-14  
Accessing the paper settings......................................................12-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Machine setting menu  
By pressing [Setting] on the control panel, you can see the machine setting menu.  
12-2 MACHINE SETTINGS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copy settings  
The copy settings allow you to customize various copy settings to match your needs.  
Accessing the copy settings  
Press [Setting], [Copy Settings].  
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
Set or change the selected items.  
2
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
For details on each setting, refer to the following table:  
When you are finished, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
3
The underlined settings are factory defaults.  
Function  
Doc. Type  
Description  
Setting  
This sets the default setting for the resolution of the document Text, Auto, Photo, Text High-Res,  
to be copied. Matching the settings to the frequently copied  
documents can shorten the time required to adjust settings.  
Text&Photo High-Res, Photo High-Res  
Contrast  
Sort  
This sets the default setting for the contrast of the document  
to be copied. Matching the settings to the frequently copied  
documents can shorten the time required to adjust settings.  
Lightest, Lighter, Normal, Darker, Darkest  
Sort will be defaulted to “Sort”. [ON] and [OFF] toggle every  
time you press [Sort].  
ON, OFF  
MACHINE SETTINGS 12-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax settings  
You can customize the fax settings to match your needs.  
This section describes [Default Settings] and [Other Settings].  
For details on other items, see below.  
• Program One-Touch (See page 10-14.)  
• Fax Forward (See page 3-51.)  
• Cover Page (See page 3-32.)  
• Batch Tx Box (See page 3-35.)  
• F-Code Box (See page 10-21.)  
Accessing the default fax settings  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings].  
1
Press [Default Settings].  
2
Set or change the selected items.  
3
For details on each setting, refer to the following table:  
When you are finished, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
12-4 MACHINE SETTINGS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The underlined settings are factory defaults.  
Function  
Description  
Setting  
Normal  
Fine  
S-Fine  
Photo  
Resolution  
This sets the default setting for the resolution of the document to be scanned. By setting  
it to a level suitable for the most commonly sent document type, you can reduce the time  
and effort required when making changes.  
Contrast  
This sets the default setting for the contrast of the document to be scanned. By setting  
it to a level suitable for the most commonly sent document type, you can reduce the time  
and effort required when making changes.  
Lightest  
Lighter  
Normal  
Darker  
Darkest  
1
2
TTI  
Set to [ON] to send the TTI information.  
[ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [TTI].  
ON  
OFF  
3
Memory Tx  
(See page 3-5)  
This sets whether to give the priority to memory transmission or to real-time transmis-  
sions when sending faxes. Memory transmissions are prioritized when [ON] is set and  
real-time transmissions when [OFF] is set.  
You can also select to give the priority to memory transmissions or to real-time transmis-  
sions each time you send a fax.  
ON  
OFF  
4
[ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [Memory Tx].  
5
Cover Page  
Set to [ON] to add a cover page containing a simple message to every fax.  
ON  
OFF  
(See page 3-32.) [ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [Cover Page].  
Tx Report Set to [ON] to print out a transmission report for each fax.  
(See page 13-8.) [ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [Tx Report].  
ON  
OFF  
6
Overseas Tx  
Set to [ON] to enable the overseas transmission all the time.  
[ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [OverseasTx].  
ON  
OFF  
7
8
Accessing other fax settings  
9
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings].  
1
Press [Other Settings].  
2
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Set or change the selected items.  
3
For details on each setting, refer to the following table:  
When you finish, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
MACHINE SETTINGS 12-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The underlined settings are the factory defaults.  
Function  
Description  
Setting  
Redial Attempts This sets the number of times for redial attempts when the destination line is busy. The  
interval between redial attempts is set at “Redial Interval”.  
2–15 times: 2  
times  
Redial Interval This sets the interval between redial attempts.  
1–5 minutes: 1  
minute  
Block Junk Fax This function enables you to block receipt of unnecessary faxes.  
(See page 3-46.)  
Number of  
Rings  
This sets the number of times the machine will ring before fax reception when the recep- 1–10 times: 2  
tion mode is set to Fax or Tel/Fax.  
times  
Dialing Pause  
This sets the default for the dialing interval (2-10 seconds) when the pause symbol is  
input.  
2–10 seconds: 2  
seconds  
Super-Fine  
Resolution  
This sets the dpi for resolution when a document is scanned for S-Fine transmission. If  
600 dpi is set, the scan is sharper than with 400 dpi; however, it may result in memory  
overflow when the document is sent.  
600dpi  
400dpi  
Rx Reduction  
Rate  
Select from [Auto], which automatically selects the magnification according to the length Auto  
of the received document, or [100%] to have all faxes printed out at the same rate of  
100%  
(See page 3-20.) reduction.  
Reduction  
Margin  
This sets at what point the document printout will extend to the following page if the  
received document cannot fit within the effective recordable area.  
0.0–3.3 inches:  
1.5 inches  
(See page 3-20.)  
Paper Saving  
This sets the print method for the received documents.  
OFF  
H-Page Rx  
Duplex Rx*  
(See page 3-21.) If it is set to “H-Page Rx” and 2 pages of Half-Letter is received in succession, the two  
pages will be reduced at the appropriate rate and printed out on one sheet of paper.  
If it is set to “Duplex Rx*”, both sides of each sheet of paper will be used for printouts.  
*A duplex printing unit is required for duplex reception.  
Quick Memory  
Tx  
If this is set to [ON], fax transmission for multiple documents will begin in the page order ON  
when it has been scanned and stored.  
OFF  
ECM Mode  
Any part of a fax that was not send correctly due to the line error will automatically be  
resent. (The destination must have the same function for it to work.)  
ON  
OFF  
Service Mode  
Dial PreFix  
Do not set.  
The connection number as Dial PreFix No. can be registered to allow easy access to other  
(See page 3-44.) phone networks.  
Receive Time  
Stamp  
If this is set to [ON], the received date (year, month, day) and time can be printed with  
the word “Received” at the header of the received document.  
OFF  
ON  
MAY 5 2005 02:16pm  
MAY 5 2005 02:15pm  
P.01/01  
If the receiving reduction rate is fixed to 100% and the reduction margin setting  
is small, the received document could be divided into 2 sheets by attaching the  
Receive Time Stamp.  
NOTE:  
12-6 MACHINE SETTINGS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scanner settings  
You can customize the scanner functions to match your needs.  
Accessing the default scan settings  
Press [Setting], [Scanner Settings].  
1
1
2
Press [Default Settings].  
2
3
4
5
6
Set or change the selected items.  
3
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
For details on each setting, refer to the following table:  
When you are finished, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
4
The underlined settings are factory defaults.  
Function  
Doc. Type  
Description  
Setting  
This sets the default setting for the resolution of the document to be scanned.  
Matching the settings to the frequently scanned documents can shorten the time  
required to adjust settings.  
Text, Auto, Photo  
Contrast  
This sets the default setting for the contrast of the document to be scanned.  
Matching the settings to the frequently scanned documents can shorten the time Darker, Darkest  
required to adjust settings.  
Lightest, Lighter, Normal,  
Resolution  
This sets the resolution when scanning the document. You can set the different  
settings for monochrome documents and color documents.  
• Monochrome  
200dpi, 300dpi, 600dpi  
• Color  
100dpi, 200dpi, 300dpi,  
600dpi  
File Format  
Select the default file format for scanning. You can set the different file format  
for monochrome documents and color documents respectively.  
• Monochrome  
TIFF, PDF  
• Color  
JPEG, PDF  
MACHINE SETTINGS 12-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessing other scan settings  
Press [Setting], [Scanner Settings].  
1
Set or change the selected items.  
2
For details on each setting, refer to the following table:  
When you are finished, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
3
The underlined settings are the factory defaults.  
Function  
Description  
Setting  
File Name  
You can register a file name in advance for scanned file. If you register a file  
name, you can choose it instead of entering a file name when scanning a docu-  
ment.  
For details of registering  
a file name, see page 5-8.  
Folder Shortcut You can create a shortcut of Windows shared folder on your machine. You can  
also edit or delete the created shortcuts.  
For details of registering  
a folder shortcut, see  
page 5-35.  
FTP Shortcut  
You can create a shortcut of FTP server on your machine. You can also edit or  
delete the created shortcuts.  
For details of registering  
FTP shortcut, see page  
5-49.  
12-8 MACHINE SETTINGS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mail settings  
You can customize the mail settings to match your needs.  
Accessing the mail settings  
Press [Setting], [Mail Settings].  
1
1
Press [I-Fax] or [e-mail] for the individual settings of internet fax and e-mail.  
2
2
Set or change the selected items.  
3
4
5
6
7
For details on each setting, refer to the following table:  
8
When you are finished, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
3
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
MACHINE SETTINGS 12-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When you press [I-Fax]  
The underlined settings are the factory defaults.  
Function  
File Format  
Batch Scan  
Description  
Select the default file format for scanning.  
Setting  
TIFF-S, TIFF-F, PDF  
When you set it to [OFF], you can divide the scanned documents into page unit  
to send it as a separate e-mail respectively.  
ON, OFF  
See page 4-11.  
When you press [e-mail]  
The underlined settings are the factory defaults.  
Function  
Description  
Setting  
File Format  
Select the default file format for scanning. You can set the different file format  
for monochrome documents and color documents respectively.  
• Monochrome  
TIFF, PDF  
• Color  
JPEG, PDF  
See page 5-60.  
Batch Scan  
When you set it to [OFF], you can divide the scanned documents into page unit  
to send it as a separate e-mail respectively.  
ON, OFF  
See page 5-59.  
When you press [Subject]  
The underlined settings are the factory defaults.  
Function  
Subject  
Description  
Setting  
When you set it to [ON], you can select the subject and the message attached  
to e-mail. The selected subject and message will be attached to all e-mail to be  
sent if you have not entered them for an e-mail transmission.  
The e-mail template can be registered using the web browser. (Refer to “E-mail  
settings” on the “Network Guide”)  
ON, OFF  
See page 4-7, 5-24.  
12-10 MACHINE SETTINGS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Management settings  
You can customize settings on your machine to match your needs.  
Accessing the management settings  
Press [Setting], [Management].  
1
1
Set or change the selected items using [Prev] and [Next].  
2
2
3
4
5
6
7
For details on each setting, refer to the following table:  
When you are finished, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
3
8
The underlined settings are factory defaults.  
9
Function  
Description  
Setting  
Network Set-  
tings  
You can configure the network settings to use your machine on the TCP/IP  
network.  
For details of network  
settings, see “Network  
Guide” contained in this  
product.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Soft Key  
You can change the “Soft keys” displayed in the standby mode.  
See “Programming a soft  
key” on page 10-5.  
Auto Reset  
Time  
This sets the period of time before the copy/fax/scanner display returns to the  
standby mode.  
Copy and Scanner screens  
“Reset time”  
:When the machine does not operate for a set period of  
time after copying or scanning is completed, the selected  
settings are reset (returned to their original values). The  
reset time can be set.  
• Reset time  
1 to 10 minutes:  
3 minutes  
“Reset After Scan” :Setting it to [ON] resets the resolution, resizing, and other • Reset After Scan  
settings after the document is scanned. Setting it to [OFF]  
resets the values after the selected reset time has elapsed.  
ON  
OFF  
Fax screen  
When the machine does not operate for a set period of time after faxing, the  
selected settings are reset (returned to their original values). You can set the  
reset time.  
• Reset time  
1 to 10 minutes:  
3 minutes  
MACHINE SETTINGS 12-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Function  
Description  
Setting  
Sound Settings You can set the various sounds.  
Buzzer and Key Touch Volume  
You can adjust the volume of the various sounds emitted by the machine.  
OFF  
Low  
Middle  
High  
Key Touch Tone  
You can change the tone emitted when pressing the buttons.  
Different tones can be set for fax, copy and scanner.  
• Fax  
High Mid Low  
• Copy  
High Mid Low  
• Scanner  
High Mid Low  
Fax Ringer  
You can set the ringer for fax reception even if the optional handset is not  
used.  
OFF  
ON  
Complete beep  
You can confirm when each operation (copy, fax, e-mail, scan etc.) is completed OFF  
by sound.  
Type 1  
Type 2  
• Copy Complete ................. When copying has finished  
• Transmission Complete... When a fax/an internet fax/a scan to e-mail/a scan Type 3  
to folder/a scan to FTP have been sent  
• Rx Complete ..................... When a fax has been received  
• Rx Print Complete ........... When printing a received document has finished  
Press [Test] to hear the selected sounds.  
NOTE:  
ON  
OFF  
Paper Jam Alarm  
Sound an alarm tone when a paper jam occurs.  
Energy Save  
Mode  
You can set the transition time to the energy save mode and whether to enable  
the transition time you set.  
(See page 1-23)  
You can put the machine into energy save mode by pressing [Energy  
Save], regardless of this settings.  
NOTE:  
“Energy Save Mode” :When you set it to [OFF], [Energy Save Time] setting is  
disabled. To enter the energy save mode, press [Energy  
Save].  
ON  
OFF  
1 to 100 minutes:  
“Energy Save Time” :If the machine is not used for the period of time set here, 5 minutes  
it automatically switches to the energy save mode.  
Auto Print  
Journal  
When turned [ON], the machine automatically prints a Tx & Rx Report once 100 ON  
faxes and e-mail have been sent or received.  
OFF  
See “Printing journal  
report automatically” on  
page 13-6.  
Tx Report and Rx Report cannot be automatically printed.  
NOTE:  
Journal Line  
Up  
When turned [ON], you can sort the report by the executed time. This can make ON  
it easier to locate specific jobs and to confirm job status. When turned [OFF], the OFF  
report will be sorted by command.  
Protect  
Passcode  
You can register the protect passcode required for using the security functions.  
To change the protect code, you must enter the old one first. Enter 0000 to delete registered at shipment.  
the protect passcode.  
No protect passcode is  
12-12 MACHINE SETTINGS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Function  
Description  
Setting  
Department  
Management  
You can limit who uses the machine for sending faxes and making copies by  
requiring input of a department code. Also, register the charge per 1 sheet of  
copy when you collect the copy charge.  
See “Department manage-  
ment” on page 11-13.  
Security  
Reception  
You can use this function to receive and store the faxes in memory, but not print See “Security receptioon”  
them. This function is useful when no one is in the office, for example, at night.  
You can print them later.  
on page 11-3.  
Display Jobs in The number of out-of-paper receptions and copies waiting to be printed is  
See “If paper runs out  
during fax reception”on  
page 3-17.  
See “Checking the copy  
print queue” on page 7-28.  
1
Queue  
displayed.  
2
Copy Protect  
PIN Mode  
Prohibits copying.  
ON  
OFF  
When pressed [ON], the display will not switch to the copy mode even if [Copy]  
is pressed.  
Fax & copy mode will not be possible.  
3
When pressing [Mode 1] or [Mode 2] if required to enter the PIN (personal iden- OFF  
tification number) for making a long distance call, the PIN will not appear in a  
journal, error message printout or a transmit confirmation report.  
Mode 1  
Mode 2  
See “PIN masking” on  
page 11-7.  
4
5
Scan Lamp  
Sleep Mode  
You can specify the sleep period of the scanner lamp to prolong its life.  
While scanner lamp is in the sleep mode, it will take a few moments to light the OFF  
scanner lamp completely to scan a document. Start Time: 10:00 pm  
ON  
6
Reset Time: 06:00 am  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
MACHINE SETTINGS 12-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper settings  
You can customize the paper settings to match your needs.  
Accessing the paper settings  
Press [Setting], [Paper Settings].  
1
Set or change the selected items.  
2
For details on each setting, refer to the following table:  
When you are finished, press [Reset] to return to the standby mode.  
3
The underlined settings are the factory defaults.  
Function  
Description  
Setting  
Cassette XX  
Paper  
You can register the size of paper used in the cassette. Operation can be simpli-  
fied by registering the paper size frequently used when using the cassette.  
See “Setting the paper  
size” on page 1-30.  
Bypass Tray  
Paper  
You can register the type or size of paper used in the bypass tray.  
Operation can be simplified by registering the paper size frequently used when  
using the bypass tray.  
See “Setting the paper  
size” on page 1-30.  
Select Print  
Cassette  
You can set the cassette using range for cassette 1, cassette 2 and bypass tray  
respectively.  
“Not Use” : This cassette is not used for receiving faxes and copying. You can  
use it for PC printing and separate reception page.  
Not Use  
Fax  
Copy  
Fax&Copy  
“Fax”  
: Use this cassette when receiving faxes or internet faxes, and print-  
ing a list.  
“Copy”  
: Use this cassette when copying.  
“Fax&Copy” : Use this cassette when receiving faxes or internet faxes, printing a  
list and copying.  
• Priority of cassette to be used is cassette 1 -> cassette 2 (option) ->  
bypass tray.  
NOTE:  
• When you set “Separate Reception Page” to ON, you cannot select  
[Not Use] or [Copy] for the cassette specified in “Separate Reception  
Page”.  
• 2nd cassette is displayed when installed in the machine.  
Separate  
Reception Page  
Partition each received document by inserting a separator page.  
See “Separator page” on  
page 3-57.  
The settings for the various functions set under Paper Settings are printed out  
in the System Settings List. (See page 13-2.)  
NOTE:  
12-14 MACHINE SETTINGS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
13  
Report & Lists  
Lists and journal reports.....................................................................13-2  
Activity journal ....................................................................................13-5  
Setting the activity journal ..........................................................13-5  
Printing the activity journal manually........................................13-6  
Setting the order on the activity journal.....................................13-7  
Transmission confirmation report ......................................................13-8  
Setting the transmission confirmation report.............................13-8  
Stored document list............................................................................13-9  
Erased document notification............................................................13-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lists and journal reports  
The following table outlines the lists and journal reports that your machine can print out.  
Name  
Description  
Address Book List  
Lists the address book numbers, names and fax number/e-mail  
addresses you have stored.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Address Book], then [Yes].  
Group List  
Lists the address book numbers, name and fax number/e-mail address  
you have stored into group.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Group], then select the group  
name and press [Yes].  
Command List  
Lists the following items:  
• Command number  
• Address book numbers, fax numbers and e-mail addresses of the  
destination  
• Start time (dd,hh:mm format)  
• Note — The specified functions are printed.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Journal List], [Command  
List], then [Yes].  
Journal  
Report  
Tx Report You can print the transmission report for the fax/internet fax/e-mail  
transmission.  
To print the report, press [Setting], [List], [Journal List], [Journal  
Report], [Tx Report], then [Yes].  
Rx Report You can print the reception report for the fax/internet fax/e-mail  
reception.  
To print the report, press [Setting], [List], [Journal List], [Journal  
Report], [Rx Report], then [Yes].  
Tx & Rx  
Report  
You can print the transmission and reception report for the latest 100  
fax transaction and latest 100 internet fax/e-mail transaction.  
To print the report, press [Setting], [List], [Journal List], [Journal  
Report], [Tx&Rx Report], then [Yes].  
Copy Settings List  
Fax Settings List  
Scanner Settings List  
System Settings List  
Function List  
Lists the current copy settings.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Copy Set-  
tings], then [Yes].  
Lists the current fax settings.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Fax Settings],  
then [Yes].  
Lists the current scanner settings.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Scanner Set-  
tings], then [Yes].  
Lists the current machine settings.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [System Set-  
tings], then [Yes].  
Prints the functions available on your machine.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Function  
List], then [Yes].  
13-2 REPORT & LISTS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Name  
Description  
Store Doc. List  
Prints how much memory each stored document is using.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Store Doc  
List], then [Yes].  
Department List  
Macro List  
Lists total communication time, printed pages of fax reception, total  
copy page, copy charge and the sum of copy charge.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Department  
List], then [Yes].  
1
2
Lists the each key’s Macro key number and the name of the job stored  
in the Macro key.  
To print a program list, press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Macro  
List], then [Yes].  
3
Program One-Touch  
List  
Lists the program one-touch number, the address book number and  
the fax number, the time to start transmission, each program one-  
touch setting assigned to each key for program one-touch.  
To print the list, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Program One-  
Touch], then [Yes].  
4
5
Fax Forward List  
Lists the each transfer rule’s identifier number, remote fax’s number  
where you want documents to be transferred, ON/OFF setting, time  
period and auto print setting.  
To print a program list, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Fax  
Forward], then [Yes].  
6
7
8
Cover Page  
Prints a sample cover page.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Cover Page],  
then [Yes].  
9
Batch Tx Doc. List  
Batch Tx Box List  
Lists the box names and the documents’ file numbers.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Batch Tx Doc.],  
then [Yes].  
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Lists each box name, address book number and fax number and day  
and time the transmission should start.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Batch Tx Box],  
then [Yes].  
F-Code Box List  
F-Code Doc. List  
Block Junk Fax List  
Lists each box’s identifier number, box name (if any), sub-address,  
password, box type and each box’s settings.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [F-Code Box],  
then [Yes].  
Lists the each box’s identifier number, box name (if any), box type and  
each file number (or document number) that is stored.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [F-Code Doc.],  
then [Yes].  
Lists blocked phone numbers.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Other Lists], [Block Junk  
Fax], then [Yes].  
Network Settings List Lists the currently network settings.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Network Settings], then  
[Yes].  
REPORT & LISTS 13-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Name  
Description  
Folder Shortcut List  
Lists each shortcut’s identifier number, the shortcut name and the  
link destination.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [Folder Shortcut], then [Yes].  
FTP Shortcut List  
Lists each shortcut’s identifier number, the shortcut name and the  
link destination.  
To print this list, press [Setting], [List], [FTP Shortcut], then [Yes].  
Tx confirmation report Prints after document transmission.  
13-4 REPORT & LISTS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Activity journal  
Just as a checkbook records your daily financial transactions, your machine keeps  
an activity journal which records the 100 most recent fax, internet fax and scan to  
e-mail transactions. The activity journal lists the following information for each  
transaction:  
• Assigned number, starting each day at 001 (fax only)  
• Remote location called  
• Resolution mode (fax only)  
• Starting date and time  
• Duration, in minutes and seconds (fax only)  
• Number of pages (fax only)  
1
2
3
• Department code (fax only) (See page 11-13.)  
• Result of the call — If preceded by an asterisk (*), this signifies an ECM com-  
munication. If preceded by a pound (#), this signifies communication was via  
a highspeed V.34 modem.  
• Any special operations — For example, “Manual” will appear if you made a  
fax call using an external telephone.  
4
5
6
Setting the activity journal  
7
Your fax machine will print the activity journal automatically after 100 transac-  
tions.  
8
Either [Tx Report] or [Rx Report] cannot be printed out automatically.  
NOTE:  
9
Press [Setting], [Management], [Auto Print Journal].  
1
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
Select [ON] and press [Enter].  
2
REPORT & LISTS 13-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing the activity journal manually  
To print an activity journal immediately without waiting for 100 transmissions to  
be completed:  
Press [Setting], [List], [Journal List].  
1
Press [Journal Report].  
2
Select the journal type you want to print.  
• [Tx Report] prints fax/internet fax/scan to e-mail transmission reports only.  
3
• [Rx Report] prints fax/internet fax/scan to e-mail reception reports only.  
• [Tx & Rx Report] prints both fax/internet fax/scan to e-mail transmission and  
reception reports.  
When the confirmation message appears, press [Yes] to print it.  
4
13-6 REPORT & LISTS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting the order on the activity journal  
Your machine will list every fax transmission (and attempt) on the activity journal.  
For example, if your machine has to redial a call the redials will appear on the  
journal.  
If you want to list those activities by the executed time, you can change the order  
on the activity journal.  
To change the order:  
1
Press [Setting], [Management], [Next], [Journal Line Up].  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Select [ON] or [OFF].  
2
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
If you want the activity journal to print listing the transmissions by the  
executed time, press [ON].  
Otherwise, The machine lists the fax transaction per command.  
Press [Enter].  
3
REPORT & LISTS 13-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission confirmation report  
Setting the transmission confirmation report  
Your machine can print a transmit confirmation report (TCR) after sending a fax or  
internet fax to any Group 3 fax machine. The TCR lists the following information for  
each communication:  
• Date and time of the TCR’s printout • Destination to send (fax or internet fax)  
• Resolution mode  
• Number of pages  
• Starting date and time  
• Sending results (of fax/internet fax)  
• Any special operations — For example, “BrdCast” will appear when you per-  
form a broadcast transmission.  
• Sample of the document — An reduced image of the first page of the docu-  
ment will appear.  
To activate the transmission confirmation report:  
Press [Setting], [Fax Settings], [Default Settings], [Tx Report].  
1
When you want to set the transmission confirmation report, set it to [ON].  
[ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [Tx Report].  
2
NOTE: • When you want to temporarily change the transmission confirmation report  
setting, perform the following procedure:  
After the transmission has been completed the Tx Report setting will return  
to the default setting.  
1 Press [FAX], [Others].  
2 Press [Tx Report] to change the setting.  
[ON] and [OFF] toggle every time you press [Tx Report].  
3 Press [Enter].  
You can assign [Tx Report] to the soft key. See “Soft keys” on page 10-2.  
13-8 REPORT & LISTS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stored document list  
Your machine can print a list of documents stored in memory. It will tell you how  
much memory each document is using.  
The list information includes:  
• Type — The document type, such as “Tx Doc”.  
• Data (in Kbyte) — How much memory is used for the document.  
• Page — Number of pages.  
1
• Note — Other information, such as the command number.  
2
To print the list of documents stored in memory:  
Press [Setting], [List], [Settings List], [Store Doc List], then [Yes].  
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
AI  
REPORT & LISTS 13-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Erased document notification  
• When documents stored in memory are accidentally erased, a notification will be  
printed when the power has been restored that outlines the erased documents  
information.  
• The following is an example of a received file that has been erased. In addition,  
“Command erased”, “Erased Poll Documents” and “F-Code box document erased”  
may be printed.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1. No. — Number of the communication  
8. Remarks —  
Manual:  
Manual reception  
Internet fax reception  
2. Name — Registered in the following order  
(1) TTI number registered for the  
destination name  
I-Fax:  
PC-FAX  
(2) Space  
3. Mode — Resolution used for the communication  
4. Start Time — Time the communication started  
5. Time — Time required for the communication  
6. Page — Number of pages received  
7. Result — Communications results.  
OK:  
*:  
#:  
Completed normally  
Communicated in ECM mode  
Communicated via super G3  
Error code: Finished abnormally  
(For information regarding error  
codes, refer to page 14-24.)  
13-10 REPORT & LISTS  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
14  
Maintenance & Troubleshooting  
Maintenance.........................................................................................14-2  
Cleaning tips.................................................................................14-2  
Cleaning the scanning area..........................................................14-2  
Cleaning the ADF rollers..............................................................14-3  
Cleaning the drum charge wire and the print head ...................14-3  
Replacing the toner cartridge.......................................................14-5  
Replacing the drum cartridge ......................................................14-7  
Troubleshooting ...................................................................................14-9  
Document jams .............................................................................14-9  
Paper jams...................................................................................14-13  
Displayed error messages...........................................................14-16  
“Check Message” printouts.........................................................14-23  
Error codes ..................................................................................14-24  
Machine errors............................................................................14-26  
Faxing errors...............................................................................14-26  
Scanning errors...........................................................................14-27  
Copying errors.............................................................................14-27  
PC printing errors.......................................................................14-27  
Local Scanner errors...................................................................14-28  
Print quality problems................................................................14-29  
If you cannot solve the problem .................................................14-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
Cleaning tips  
To obtain optimal machine performance please follow these guidelines:  
Clean your machine regularly! Dust and dirt, especially around the fax  
machine’s air vents can shorten your machine’s life.  
Always unplug the machine before you clean it.  
Never spray any cleaner directly onto your machine. The drifting spray  
could damage the components inside.  
Never try to clean sealed areas inside your machine. They are sealed for  
both your safety and the safety of your machine.  
• When cleaning the machine’s exterior, use a mild cleaning solution sprayed onto a  
lint-free cloth.  
• In areas you cannot reach with a swab, always use dry, dust-free compressed air  
to gently blow away dust and other material.  
Cleaning the scanning area  
F-560/F-520 model  
Wipe the ADF glass with a clean, soft, lint-free cloth moistened with water.  
1
2
Then use a clean, soft, dry, lint-free cloth to dry the glass.  
ADF glass  
MFX-2030/MFX-1430 model  
Wipe the document glass, ADF glass and document pad with a clean, soft, lint-  
free cloth moistened with water.  
1
Then wipe it with a clean, soft, dry, lint-free cloth until it is clean and dry.  
2
Document pad  
ADF glass  
Document glass  
14-2 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cleaning the ADF rollers  
If you are having document feeding issues, try this procedure:  
Turn off the power and disconnect the power cable from the wall outlet.  
1
2
3
Open the ADF cover.  
1
Use a cloth moistened with a rubber roller cleaner to clean the face of the roll-  
ers.  
Rotate the rollers by hand to clean the entire roller surface.  
2
3
4
5
6
7
Cleaning the drum charge wire and the print head  
When the following message appears on the display or if you are experiencing poor  
print quality, the charge wire needs to be cleaned.  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
NOTE: Your machine will print approximately 100 pages after this message appears,  
after the maximum number of prints has been reached the machine will display  
a “Printer Not Usable” message and will not allow any further print jobs to take  
place. This will prevent your machine from becoming permanently damaged.  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To clean the charge wire  
Open the front cover.  
1
2
Gently pull the blue cleaning rod toward you, making sure it fully extends.  
Then return the rod to its original position. This operation also cleans the print  
head.  
Instruction  
Pull the blue rod toward  
you,making sure it fully  
extends.  
A
1
2
Return the rod to its  
original position.  
Close the front cover.  
3
14-4 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacing the toner cartridge  
When the toner runs out, your machine will show “Toner should be replaced” on the  
display and it will not print until the toner cartridge is replaced.  
To replace the toner cartridge:  
Open the front cover.  
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
Turn the toner cartridge locking lever to the left (unlock position).  
2
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Pull the used toner cartridge out.  
3
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Unpack the toner cartridge from its carton. Then, holding the toner cartridge  
with both hands, gently shake it to distribute the toner evenly inside the car-  
tridge.  
4
NOTE: Do not touch the roller on the toner cartridge.  
Slide the toner cartridge into the machine firmly until it locks into place.  
5
Turn the cartridge locking lever to the right until it locks into place.  
6
Close the front cover.  
7
14-6 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacing the drum cartridge  
When the drum is near the end of life, the machine will show “The drum is low”  
on the display. You should obtain a replacement drum cartridge soon. When the  
machine shows “Drum should be replaced”, it cannot print until the drum cartridge  
has been replaced.  
To replace the drum cartridge:  
1
Open the side cover and front cover.  
1
2
Turn the toner cartridge locking lever to the left (unlock position), then pull the  
2
toner cartridge out. The toner cartridge must be removed to replace the drum  
cartridge.  
3
4
5
6
7
8
Pull the used drum cartridge out.  
3
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Unpack the new drum cartridge from its carton and slide it into the machine  
firmly until it locks into place.  
4
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reinstall the toner cartridge and turn the cartridge locking lever to the right  
until it locks into place.  
5
Close the front and side cover.  
6
14-8 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
Document jams  
Case 1:  
If a document jams in the ADF, the following display will appear.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Also, if a document jam occurs during a quick memory transmission or real time  
transmission, the following message will print and detail which page has jammed.  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Case 2:  
If a document jams while scanning into memory for sort copy or normal memory  
transmission, the machine will show:  
If you want to continue the operation, press [Yes] and proceed to step 2.  
To abort the operation, press [No].  
1
NOTE: If the machine is left idle for 3 minutes, the machine will abort the operation  
automatically.  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The machine will show which page (i.e., which page number) is jammed. Clear  
the document jam and reset the document in the ADF (you do not need to start  
the entire job over, simply start with the page that was jammed), then press  
[Start].  
2
NOTE: • If the machine is left idle for 3 minutes, the machine will begin to send or  
copy the document(s) it has stored in memory.  
• If you wish to cancel this operation, press [Stop]. The machine will delete the  
entire job that was stored in memory and then return to the standby mode.  
14-10 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Jam in the document feeder  
Open the ADF cover.  
1
1
2
3
Gently remove the document from the ADF.  
If you cannot remove it, turn the release knob to remove the jammed document.  
2
4
5
6
7
8
9
Close the ADF cover, making sure both sides are snapped down securely.  
3
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
NOTE: To prevent document jam, use the document glass for wrinkled or torn docu-  
ments.  
Jammed in feed area  
Open the platen cover. Open the ADF cover and turn the release knob to  
remove the jammed document.  
1
Close the platen cover and the ADF cover.  
2
NOTE: To prevent document jam, use the document glass for wrinkled or torn docu-  
ments.  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Jammed in exit area  
Open the platen cover. Gently pull the jammed document. If you cannot it, open  
the ADF cover and turn the release knob to remove the jammed document.  
1
Close the platen cover and the ADF cover.  
2
NOTE: To prevent document jam, use the document glass for wrinkled or torn docu-  
ments.  
14-12 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper jams  
If a paper jam occurs, the following display will appear.  
1
2
3
Follow these procedures to clear the paper jam.  
4
If a paper jam occurs during fax reception, the machine will store the received  
document into memory and print them automatically once the paper jam has been  
cleared.  
5
CAUTION: When you open the side cover to remove the paper, DO NOT touch the fuser  
6
roller. The fuser unit is very hot.  
7
IMPORTANT:Do not touch the drum cartridge surface. Scratches or smudges will result in  
poor print quality.  
8
Removing jammed paper  
Pull the release lever to open the side cover.  
If the optional second cassette has been attached, open the 2nd side cover as well.  
9
1
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Carefully remove the jammed paper in the direction shown.  
2
NOTE: Avoid getting loose toner on your hands and clothes when removing the  
jammed paper.  
Jam in the feed area  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Jam in the fuser area  
Jam in the paper exit area  
If the jammed paper was partially fed and you cannot remove it easily:  
Open the paper cassette. Pull it out completely, lifting the front part of the cas-  
sette up to release the cassette from the machine.  
3
Carefully remove the jammed paper.  
4
14-14 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Close the side cover and insert the paper cassette. Lower the rear part of the  
cassette to align with the the slot of the machine, then insert it.  
5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displayed error messages  
Occasionally, your machine encounters some trouble transmitting or receiving docu-  
ments. When it does an alarm will sound alerting you to the issue. You can identify  
the problem with by reading the displayed or printed messages.  
Message on the display  
Description / Solution  
You tried to set [Sort] to [OFF] while Duplex Copy. Duplex Copy should be combined  
with sort.  
[Sort] must be turned  
On when making a  
duplex copy.  
You cannot add/enter destinations to the Address Book while selecting other destina-  
tions.  
Add/Edit cannot be  
performed.  
ADF is unavailable.  
Set the document on the  
FBS glass.  
You tried to make a Card Copy using the ADF. Use the document glass.  
There is a delayed manual transmission to be sent. To edit the Fax Setting or run a  
Macro program, wait until the job is done or cancel the job.  
ADF used in the feeder  
command.  
You tried to select a number that has already been selected. Enter a different number.  
Already stored.  
You tried to scan to folder with files attached and save them to the same folder where  
the attached files are originally saved.  
An attachment cannot  
be scanned to the folder  
from which it was  
added.  
You cannot set “0000” as an I.D. Code for Security box.  
An I.D.Code is needed.  
The advanced search failed due to an internal machine error. Check the LDAP server  
setting again, and try the search again. For more information about LDAP server set  
up, refer to the “Network Guide”.  
An LDAP server has  
not been registered.  
Check the LDAP server  
settings.  
An LDAP server has not  
been selected.Check the  
LDAP server settings.  
LDAP server has not been set up. To use the advanced search, set up the LADP server  
on your machine prior to searching. For more information, refer to the “Network Guide”.  
An LDAP server must  
be registered  
Auto ratio is selected automatically.  
To specify the zoom ratio, press [Zoom] and enter your desired zoom ratio.  
Auto ratio is set.  
You tried to erase an F-Code box which contains at least one document.  
Erase the document(s), then try again.  
Box in use.  
You tried to set Broadcast to [OFF] after multiple destinations have been selected.  
Broadcast cannot be  
turned off.  
The scanner is warming up now.  
Calibrating Scanner  
Call Service :Code  
An internal error has occurred. Contact your Muratec dealer.  
The cassette/tray you selected is used for separator page. Select other cassette/tray.  
Cannot change the  
setting for Rx separator  
cassette.  
Cannot combine with  
Card copy.  
Your selected function cannot be combined with card copy.  
The stored commands are full. Wait until one or more jobs are done.  
Cannot enter additional  
commands  
DHCP configuration failed. Check the Network setting. For more information, refer to  
the “Network Guide”.  
Cannot find the domain  
You tried to switch the mode to others while Fax&Copy mode. Changing mode in  
Fax&Copy is not available.  
Cannot select mode dur-  
ing Fax&Copy  
14-16 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message on the display  
Description / Solution  
You tried to store a document in an F-code Secure box. If you need to store documents,  
use an F-code Bulletin box.  
Cannot store in a secure  
box.  
You cannot use the same protect code for “Read/Write” and “Read Only”. Enter a differ-  
ent one.  
Cannot use the same  
code for both Read/Write  
and Read Only.  
The selected paper is not suitable for copying or printing. Select other paper source.  
Check Paper Source  
1
The loaded paper does not match the paper registered in the machine.  
Set correct sized paper or change the paper size setting.  
Open and close the front cover to reset the printer.  
Check the paper size.  
Open & Close Front  
cover.  
2
The cover indicated on the display is open or has not been closed securely. Close it  
properly.  
Close XXX Cover  
3
The paper cassette indicated on the LCD is open or has not been closed securely. Close  
it properly.  
Close XXX cassette  
4
The scanner unit is open. Close the scanner unit.  
Close the Scanner Unit  
Communication error  
A communication error disrupted the reception or transmission. If you were trans-  
mitting, press [Stop] to clear the error message and then re-try the transmission. If  
you were receiving a fax, try to contact the other person and have him/her re-try the  
transmission.  
5
6
The function is not available during communication. Wait until it ends.  
Communication in  
progress.  
7
An internal error has occurred. Contact your Muratec dealer.  
Contact service for  
printer option  
The document has jammed while being stored into memory. To continue storing press  
[Yes], to cancel the job press [No].  
Continue to store?  
[Yes] [No]  
8
Copy is protected.  
To copy, set [Copy protect] to [OFF].  
During copy protection, Macro program is disabled.  
Copy protected  
9
Copy reservation is disable. Wait until the present job is completed.  
Copy reservation has  
been disabled.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Close XXX Cover  
Cover Open  
The cover indicated on the LCD is open or has not been closed securely. Close it prop-  
erly.  
DHCP configuration failed. Check the network connection. If the LAN cable is not con-  
nected, connect it to the machine to connect to the LAN.  
If the DHCP server is not installed on your network, turn off the “DHCP setting” and  
register the IP address manually.  
DHCP server did not  
respond.  
For more information, refer to the “Network Guide”.  
You are selecting a non-registered address book number. Check the address book num-  
ber and try again.  
Dialing number has not  
been set.  
You tried to store a document in a Batch Tx box, but the machine has reached its capac-  
ity (40 documents). Delete unnecessary documents stored or use other Batch Tx box.  
Document full  
You tried to erase a batch box which contains at least one document. To erase a batch  
box, erase all the documents stored in the box.  
Document stored  
The drum cartridge has run out. Replace with a new drum cartridge.  
Drum should be  
replaced.  
No destinations are entered. Enter at least one destination to register the setting.  
The end forwarding day is not entered in Fax forward setting.  
The end forwarding time is not entered in Fax forward setting.  
The start forwarding day is not entered in Fax forward setting.  
The start forwarding time is not entered in Fax forward setting.  
Enter location.  
Enter the end day.  
Enter the end time.  
Enter the start day.  
Enter the start time.  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message on the display  
Description / Solution  
You tried to create an F-code box without entering a sub-address. Sub-address is a  
required field.  
Enter the sub-address  
The image transfer failed. Check the printed out “Check Massage” to identify the error.  
Error  
There is a manual delayed transmission reserved in the ADF. Wait until the job is  
finished, or cancel the delayed transmission by removing the document.  
Feeder In Use  
Follow the instruction that will be displayed on the screen to clean the charge wire.  
The entered passcode is wrong. Enter the correct passcode.  
Follow Instruction A  
Incorrect passcode  
A non-registered address book number is selected. Either choose another number or  
manually dial the number.  
Invalid Address Book  
Location!  
You entered invalid characters. To register a Shortcut, insert the PC name between “//”  
and “/”. To register a File Name, special characters such as “\”, “/”, “:”, “*”, “?”, “<”, “>”  
or “|” cannot be entered. To register NetBIOS characters other than the alphabet and  
numbers between 1 to 9.  
Invalid characters have  
been entered.  
The F-code box I.D. code you entered is not valid. Try re-entering your F-code box I.D.  
code.  
Invalid I.D.code  
You entered a number which is not valid for the current operation.  
Invalid number!  
The selected paper is not suitable for duplex printing. Select other paper source. Select  
plain paper in the size of Letter or Legal.  
Invalid Paper Size  
You entered an invalid value or pressed [Enter] without entering a value.  
– or –  
Invalid parameters!  
The advanced search failed due to an internal machine error. Check the LDAP server  
setting, and try the search again. For more information about LDAP server set up, refer  
to the “Network Guide”.  
You selected to continue the job. The machine is instructing you from which page to set  
the document. Set the document again from that page that the machine is indicating  
you and press [Start]. To cancel and finish the job, press[Cancel].  
Jam Recover.  
Set the document. Press  
[Start].  
From Page :  
[Start] [Cancel]  
The scanner lamp is dim or not operating.  
Make repeated copies to help evaporate any internal moisture. If that doesn’t resolve  
the problem, contact your Muratec dealer.  
Lamp error. Call for  
service.  
The advanced search failed due to an internal machine error. Try the search again.  
LDAP reference execu-  
tion error  
You tried to register a shortcut without entering [Link]. To register a Folder or FTP  
server shortcut, you should enter the [Link].  
Link Path is required.  
Load the paper specified by the machine.  
Load XXX paper  
Load paper  
There is no paper either in the cassette or in the bypass tray. Load paper.  
The paper run out during fax reception. Load paper.  
Load paper for reception  
There is no paper either in the cassette or in the bypass tray. Load paper.  
Load paper in the  
bypass tray  
There is no paper in the XXX cassette. Load paper in it.  
Load paper into the  
XXX cassette  
You cannot press [Macro Program] while you are registering a Macro.  
Macro in use  
The transmission failed. Check the printed out “Check Massage” to identify the error.  
Mail transmission error  
There is not enough memory to store the print job. Wait until some reserved jobs are  
finished and the memory becomes free.  
Memory full. Printing  
will resume when mem.  
is free.Press [OnLine]  
to stop.  
Memory has overflowed during the fax reception.  
Press [Stop] to return the standby screen.  
Memory overflow Rx  
14-18 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message on the display  
Description / Solution  
You tried to enter more pages into memory than your machine could store.  
Memory overflow.  
You tried to store more pages into memory than your machine could store. Press [Yes] to  
keep the scanned pages in memory, or press [No] to delete all pages stored during this  
operation. The display shows how many pages are stored.  
Memory overflow. Num-  
ber of stored page: Store  
these pages?  
[Yes] [No]  
You need to enter a name for the registration.  
Name is required  
1
You pressed [Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.] to review upcoming commands, but your  
machine has no command stored.  
No command stored  
2
To set the department management on, first register the department codes.  
No department codes  
have been registered  
3
You tried to print a document from memory, but your machine has no documents in  
storage.  
No document stored  
No Drum Cartridge  
No Network Connection  
The drum cartridge is missing or has not been properly installed in your machine.  
Please properly install the drum cartridge.”  
4
The machine is not connected to the network. Check the network cable or the settings.  
For more information, refer to the “Network Guide”.  
5
The cassette/tray selected for printing is empty. Please set the paper indicated in the  
message and print your job, or press [Cancel] to cancel.  
No paper type set on  
the PC  
On XXXX  
Please set paper (Letter  
Plain)  
To cancel select [Cancel]  
6
7
The paper selected for printing is not set to the machine. Please set the paper indicated  
in the message and print your job, or press [Cancel] to cancel.  
No paper type set on  
the PC  
Please set paper (XXXX)  
To cancel select [Cancel]  
8
9
You tried to print out or delete a polling document when there is no polling document in  
memory.  
No polling document  
No protect passcode  
No report  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
To protect the Department Management, Security reception or to mask the PIN, you  
need to set the protect passcode in advance.  
You requested an activity journal or transmit confirmation report, but your machine has  
no record of any fax jobs occurring.  
The toner cartridge is missing or has not been properly installed in your machine.  
Please properly install the toner cartridge.  
No Toner Cartridge  
Not enough memory  
Not registered  
The machine cannot store documents into memory any more. Delete unnecessary docu-  
ments stored or wait until a reserved job is done.  
You pressed a key which is not programmed with any command.  
– or –  
You tried to delete a non-registered item. Non-registered items cannot be deleted.  
You tried to press [Enter], when nothing has been selected. To change the settings or to  
select destinations, first select items from the list, then press [Enter].  
Nothing has been  
selected.  
You tried to display the jobs in queue, when there is no job.  
Nothing has been  
stored.  
A document has jammed in the ADF. Follow the instruction on the display and removed  
the jammed document.  
Open & Close Scanner  
Cover  
Reset your document  
Open the front cover. The cover position is located on the display.  
Open front Cover  
Paper Count Error  
The scanned page numbers for the first side and the back side of the documents did not  
match.  
Fan the document to prevent more than one sheet being drawnthrough at a time, and  
try the operation again.  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message on the display  
Description / Solution  
The cassette/tray selected for printing has no suitable paper for printing the job. Please  
set the paper indicated in the message and print your job, or press [Cancel] to cancel.  
Paper size error for  
XXXX  
On XXXX  
Please set paper (YYYY)  
To cancel select [Cancel]  
There is no paper that fits the copying document. Select on which paper to copy or load  
paper.  
Paper supply empty.  
In PC printing, the size of paper in the paper cassette does not match up the paper size  
you specified by the printer driver. Press [Stop] to cancel a print job. Then load the cor-  
rect paper size and try printing the document again.  
PC Printing Canceled  
The telephone connected to the machine is hanging up. Hang it down.  
Phone connection ter-  
minated  
You selected “Mode1” in the PIN mask feature and tried to call an address book number  
in which no PIN has been entered, or to call using numeric keys without a PIN. Enter a  
PIN.  
PIN has not been reg-  
istered.  
The value you entered exceeds the Zoom range. Enter a value within the range.  
Please enter a value  
between 25-100%  
Please enter a value  
between 25-400%  
The value you entered exceeds the Zoom range. Enter a value within the  
range.  
You cannot view the text when there is no text entered. Enter the text in advance.  
Please enter text.  
The drum cartridge is missing or has not been properly installed in your machine.  
Please properly install the drum cartridge.  
Please install the drum  
cartridge correctly.  
The toner cartridge is missing or has not been properly installed in your machine.  
Please properly install the toner cartridge.  
Please install the toner  
cartridge correctly.  
Paper has jammed in the machine. Follow the instruction on the display and removed  
the jammed paper.  
Please Remove Paper  
The Security Reception is not set up. To use this function set up Security Reception in  
advance.  
Please set up Security  
Reception  
There is no paper either in the cassette or in the bypass tray. Load paper.  
Please Supply Paper  
Please wait...  
Your machine’s printer is either warming up or busy. Please wait until the machine is  
finished printing and then re-try your command or operation.  
Your machine’s printer is either warming up or busy. Please wait until the machine is  
finished printing and then re-try your command or operation.  
Preparing  
Document remains from the operation prior to the interrupt. Press [Stop] to discharge  
the document.  
Press [Stop] to end the  
job.  
[STOP] is pressed during fax transmission. Cancel the transmission by [Fax Cancel/Job  
Confirm.].  
Press the Fax Cancel  
key to stop the trans-  
mission.  
The machine cannot execute the job while printing. Wait until the printing is finished  
and re-try the operation.  
Printer in use  
Paper has jammed. Follow the guidance on the display and remove the paper.  
The zoom ratio is set to 100%. To change the zoom ratio, set it again.  
Printer Jam  
Ratio is set to 100%.  
You tried to send a fax using real time transmission or set memory transmission to  
[OFF] when the archive function is set up. To archive the document, use memory trans-  
mission.  
Real time transmissions  
cannot be archived.  
The machine cannot print out the job until the current communication finishes. Please  
wait.  
Real time TX in prog-  
ress. Cannot print.  
The drum cartridge has run out. Replace with a new drum cartridge.  
Remove the document from the ADF, and set them again.  
Replace the drum.  
Reset the document  
14-20 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message on the display  
Description / Solution  
To set the security reception to [OFF], first print out the stored security receipted docu-  
ment.  
Rx document stored  
Your machine’s scanner is preparing. Please wait until the machine is ready.  
The machine cannot execute the job until the current job finishes. Please wait.  
The selected paper is not suitable for the document. Select other paper.  
Scanner Adjusting  
Scanner in use  
Select Paper Size  
Select paper source  
1
There is no paper that fits the copying document. Select on which paper to copy or load  
paper.  
The paper in the bypass tray cannot print out a received fax. To use the bypass tray  
paper as a separator page, change the paper source in the bypass tray.  
Select the bypass paper  
that cannot be used for  
Rx  
2
3
The machine’s network is now preparing. Please wait until it is ready.  
An internal network error has occurred. Contact your Muratec dealer.  
Server Initializing  
Server issue. Call for  
service :error code  
4
You tried to make a [2 2side] or [2 1side] copy using the document glass. Those  
copy are only available from the ADF.  
Set document in the  
ADF.  
5
The Fax Forward is not set up. To use this function, set up the forwarding condition in  
advance.  
Set individual forward-  
ing numbers first  
6
There is no paper in the bypass tray. Load the paper indicated on the display.  
Set paper: XXXX  
The Fax Forward is not set up. To use this function set up the forwarding condition in  
advance.  
Set the individual for-  
warding numbers first  
7
You tired to create a “Read Only” protect code prior to “Read/Write” code. Create a  
“Read/Write” code first.  
Set the Read/Write  
Code first.  
8
When the machine is on the Network, you cannot set Fax Forwarding from the machine  
side. Use the browser for the setting.  
Setting must be  
changed from the  
browser  
9
The paper for separator reception has run out. Load paper in the designate cassette/  
tray.  
Supply Separator Paper  
in XXXX  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Your drum will need to be replaced soon. Please contact your Muratec dealer to pur-  
chase a new drum cartridge.  
The drum is low.  
The fax number or e-mail address is not registered to the Address Book. Either fax  
number or e-mail address must be registered.  
The following data is  
required:  
Fax or e-mail  
The fax number with PIN number or e-mail address is not registered to the Address  
Book in PIN mask mode 1. Either fax number or e-mail address must be registered. For  
fax numbers, the PIN number must also be entered after entering the fax number and  
an “*” (asterisk).  
The following data is  
required:  
Fax or e-mail, PIN  
number  
The advanced search failed due to an internal machine error. Check the LDAP server  
setting again, and try the search again. For more information about LDAP server set  
up, refer to the “Network Guide”.  
The LDAP server can-  
not be found.Check the  
LDAP server settings.  
The NetBIOS name conflicts with other device. Contact your Network Administrator.  
The NetBIOS name  
entered is already in  
use.  
You can add up to 10 network files (or up to 10 MB worth of files) to the scanned job.  
Delete files so that it meets the limit.  
The number of file  
attachments and/or  
file size limit has been  
exceeded. Please delete  
attachments until you  
reach the acceptable  
limit.  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Message on the display  
Description / Solution  
You browsed a folder where too many files or folders are located. To scan to the folder,  
register the folder as a shortcut using the [Keypad] or select another folder. To attach  
files from the folder, copy the files to a new folder and attach them.  
The number of the  
browse results exceeds  
the limit.  
You cannot use numeric keys while selecting group members.  
The machine cannot execute the job until the current job finishes. Please wait.  
Toner is empty. Replace with a new toner bottle.  
The numeric keypad  
cannot be used.  
The storing process has  
not finished.  
The toner is empty.  
The toner is low.  
Your machine is almost out of toner.  
Please contact your Muretec dealer soon to purchase a new toner cartridge.  
You entered a value or number that exceeds the range. Confirm the range on the display  
and enter it again.  
The value entered  
exceeds the limit. Please  
enter a value within the  
listed range.  
You have already registered 300 locations to the Address Book. To register a new loca-  
tion, first delete the unnecessary locations first.  
There are no vacant  
numbers.  
You selected a key on the index, to which no destination is categorized.  
There is no applicable  
data.  
You selected a function that is currently not available. Change the function you set prior  
to this function or cancel this function.  
This function cannot be  
used.  
You try to set a resolution that is not available in the set zoom ratio. Change either the  
resolution or the zoom ratio to do the job.  
This Resolution cannot  
fit specified Zoom value.  
The department management setting is protected. To change the setting, release the  
protection.  
This setting is protected  
IP address is entered or edited. Power off and then on to save the setting.  
To initialize IP address  
you must shutdown.  
Toner is empty. Replace with a new toner bottle.  
Toner should be  
replaced.  
You entered more characters than the limit. Re-enter them so that it contains the limit.  
You entered more location than the limit. Re-enter them so that it contains the limit.  
Too many characters  
Too many locations.  
The Transmit Terminal Identifier (TTI) is not registered. To select the TTI, register the  
TTI in advance.  
TTI data has not been  
registered  
The job you selected was carried out before deleting.  
Unable to delete.  
Use the scanner glass  
You tried to make a zoom up copy using the ADF. To make a zoom up copy, use  
the document glass.  
14-22 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
“Check Message” printouts  
When there is a problem with your machine detects an error, it produces an error  
printout headed by the words “Check Message”. This printout lists the following  
information about the fax transaction:  
• The resulting error code (See “Error code” next page.)  
• A communications error message (See “What error messages can mean” below.)  
• The TTI (or phone number) of the fax machine with which your machine had  
attempted to communicate.  
1
2
What error messages can mean  
The error messages on Check Message printouts can mean a variety of things. Here  
is a brief summary:  
3
Error message  
Possible meanings  
4
Check condition of remote fax.  
• Remote machine malfunctioned  
• No “Handshake” signals from remote fax  
• Wrong phone number reached  
5
Repeat transmission.  
• Poor phone line conditions  
• No “Handshake” signals from remote fax  
• Document misfeed or miscount  
6
• Unable to reach remote machine after attempt-  
ing specified number of redial tries  
7
Line is busy.  
• Remote machine’s line was busy  
• Remote machine’s line didn’t answer  
8
Check received documents.  
• Remote confirmation signal not received from  
remote fax  
• Poor line conditions caused a poor image  
9
Specified attached file(s) was not found.  
• Network setting is not set up  
• There is no connection to the network  
• The user name or password is not entered cor-  
rectly  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
• The folder is not shared  
• The folder link is not entered correctly  
Could not connect to the location.(Folder)  
Could not connect to the location.(FTP)  
Please confirm the size of attached file(s)  
• Network setting is not set up correctly  
• There is no connection to the network  
• The user name or password is not entered cor-  
rectly  
• The folder is not shared or the folder is write-  
protected  
• The folder link is not entered correctly  
• The attached files exceeds the limit. (Should be  
within 10MB.)  
Memory full.  
• Remote fax’s memory is full  
Dialing number is not set.  
Stopped.  
• Stored phone number failed to dial properly  
• Someone pressed [Stop] at the remote fax in the  
middle of the “Handshake”  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Error codes  
Dialing errors  
D.0.3,  
The remote unit didn’t respond, the call couldn’t be completed or [Stop]  
was pressed while dialing. Re-try the call. If your machine repeats the  
message, call the remote fax unit’s operator and verify that unit is oper-  
ating properly.  
D.0.8  
D.0.2  
The remote unit is busy. Try the call again.  
D.0.6,  
D.0.7  
Either the remote unit didn’t respond, the call somehow didn’t go  
through or [Stop] was pressed while dialing. Try the call again.  
Reception errors  
R.1.1  
The calling fax machine didn’t respond to your fax machine. This can  
happen if someone dials a wrong number or if the remote machine  
restricts access through use of a passcode.  
R.1.2  
The two fax machines were incompatible. Your machine sends and  
receives only ITU-T Group 3 fax communication, the industry standard  
since the early 1980s.  
R.1.4  
R.2.3  
[Stop] was pressed on the receiving fax machine.  
Poor phone line conditions made fax communication impossible. Call  
someone at the remote machine’s location.  
R.3.1  
R.3.3  
R.3.4  
The sending fax machine detected too many errors from the receiving  
fax machine.  
The sending fax machine is incompatible or had a document feeder prob-  
lem during transmission.  
Poor phone line conditions may have prevented your fax machine from  
properly printing some or all of the pages it received.  
R.4.1  
R.4.2  
The machine received too much data, overloading the memory.  
Either the line disconnected before transmission or the transmitting fax  
machine needs maintenance.  
R.4.4  
R.5.1,  
R.5.2  
The machine has reached its memory capacity.  
ECM reception failed (perhaps due to line noise).  
R.8.1  
A compatibility error occurred.  
R.8.10  
R.8.11  
Line noise or other problems prevented line probing.  
The fax machine timed out while waiting for the retrain signal.  
Transmission errors  
T.1.1  
The remote fax machine didn’t respond to your machine. Call someone at  
the remote machine’s location.  
T.1.4  
T.2.1  
[Stop] was pressed during transmission.  
Either the phone line disconnected during transmission or fax communi-  
cation became impossible due to bad phone line conditions. Try the call  
again.  
T.2.2  
T.2.3  
The two fax machines were incompatible. Your machine sends and  
receives only ITU-T Group 3 fax communication, the industry standard  
since the early 1980s.  
Bad phone line conditions made fax communication impossible. Condi-  
tions can change rapidly, so try the call again later.  
14-24 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
T.3.1  
T.4.1  
The page counter in your fax machine detected a document feeder error  
during transmission. Carefully reset the document into the feeder and  
re-try the call.  
The telephone line disconnected during transmission because of exces-  
sive modem errors or because the remote unit ran out of paper. Try the  
call again.  
T.4.2  
T.4.4  
After transmission began, poor line conditions developed. Try the call  
again.  
Poor line conditions prevented transmission. Try the call again.  
1
T.5.1,  
T.5.2,  
T.5.3  
T.8.1  
T.8.10  
T.8.11  
ECM transmission failed (perhaps due to line noise). Conditions can  
change rapidly, so try the call again later.  
2
3
A compatibility error occurred.  
Line noise or other problems prevented line probing.  
The remote fax machine didn’t complete the equalizer training phase.  
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Machine errors  
Symptom  
Suggested solutions  
Check that the power switch is turned on.  
The display shows nothing,  
and the keys are not working.  
Check that the power cord is connected properly.  
See “Displayed error messages,” on page 14-16.  
The machine is not activated  
when the power switch is  
turned on.  
The machine beeps and shows  
an error message.  
Check for the ADF cover is closed properly.  
Documents jam frequently  
If there is a foreign matter in the ADF, remove it.  
Ensure that the document is an acceptable weight. (See “Document han-  
dling,” page 1-24.)  
Clean the ADF rollers (see page 14-3.)  
Ensure that the paper is an acceptable weight. (See “Paper handling,” page  
1-26)  
Paper Jams Frequently  
Faxing errors  
Symptom  
Suggested solutions  
Check that the phone line is connected properly.  
Cannot send  
Check that the number or the e-mail address stored in your address book is  
correct.  
Make sure that the machine is in fax mode. If not, change to the mode to the  
fax mode by pressing [FAX].  
Check that the network cable is connected properly.  
Check that the network setting is made up properly.  
Your machine cannot cancel a transmission by pressing [Stop]. To cancel a trans-  
mission, press [Fax Cancel/Job Confirm.] and select a job you want to cancel,  
then press [Enter]. (See Chapter 6 “Reviewing or canceling commands” for more  
details.)  
Cannot stop transmission  
Check that the phone line is connected properly.  
Cannot receive automatically  
Check that the machine is in the automatic receiving mode (page 3-16).  
The memory may be full. If there is no paper in the cassette, set a paper to  
print the received document stored in the memory.  
Make sure that the external phone is attached to your machine to receive a  
fax manually.  
Cannot receive manually  
In manual receive mode, you must press [Start] before you hang up the  
phone.  
The memory may be full. If there is no paper in the cassette, set paper.  
Make sure that the machine is in fax mode. If not, change to the mode to the  
fax mode by pressing [FAX].  
Cannot store a document into  
memory  
The memory may be full. If there is no paper in the cassette, set the paper to  
print the received document stored in the memory.  
The number of document can be stored in the current operation is full. Delete  
unnecessary documents.  
14-26 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scanning errors  
Symptom  
Suggested solutions  
Check that your browsing folder / file is in the same segment with your  
machine.  
Cannot browse a folder / file  
Check that your folder / file is under a shared folder that name contains 12  
characters of less.  
1
Check that the link to your browsing folder is 100 characters or less in  
length.  
2
Check that the link to your browsing file is 128 characters or less in length.  
Check that the network cable is connected properly.  
Cannot scan a document  
Scanned image looks dirty  
3
Check that the network setting is made up properly.  
Check that the e-mail address stored in your address book or the folder/FTP  
shortcut is correct.  
4
Make sure that the machine is in scan mode. If not, change to the mode to the  
scan mode by pressing [SCAN].  
5
The document glass or ADF glass may be dirty.  
Clean the glass (see page 14-2.)  
6
Change the scanning contrast by pressing [Contrast].  
Change the scanning resolution by pressing [Resolution].  
Change the document type by pressing [Doc.Type].  
7
A file name or folder name  
that contains a special  
character is not correctly  
displayed and/or cannot  
open or delete it.  
The code page currently using in your Windows does not  
compatible with a special characters which can be used in your  
machine.  
To solve this issue, change the currently using code page to code  
page 850 on your Windows.  
8
9
IMPORTANT:  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
To change the code page, you will modify Windows registry.  
Before you modify the registry, make sure to back it up and  
make sure that you understand how to restore the registry if a  
problem occurs. For information about how to back up, restore,  
and edit the registry, refer to the article number 256986 in  
the Microsoft Knowledge Base (http://support.microsoft.com/  
kb/256986/en-us).  
WARNING:  
If you use Registry Editor incorrectly, you may cause serious  
problems that may require you to reinstall your operating  
system. We cannot guarantee that you can solve problems that  
result from using Registry Editor incorrectly. Use Registry Edi-  
tor at your own risk.  
To change the code page on your Windows:  
On your computer, click Start, click Run, type regedit, and  
then click OK.  
1
Locate and double-click the following registry key.  
HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\CurrentControlSet\  
Control\Nls\Codepage\OEMCP  
2
In Value data, type 850, and click OK.  
3
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying errors  
Symptom  
Suggested solutions  
Make sure that the machine is in copy mode. If not, change to the copy mode  
by pressing [COPY].  
Cannot make a copy  
Make sure that the document is loaded correctly.  
If placing the document on the document glass, the side to be copied should  
be face down. If placing the document in the ADF, the side to be copied should  
be face up.  
See “Print quality problems,” on page 14-29.  
Copy quality is poor  
PC printing errors  
*
Symptom  
Suggested solutions  
The USB cable is not connected properly. (When using as a local printer)  
Check the cable connection.  
Cannot print from your  
computer  
Check that the network cable is connected properly. (When using as a net-  
work printer)  
Check that the network setting is made up properly.(When using as a net-  
work printer)  
The port setting is incorrect.  
Check the printer port setting in your computer.  
The applicable printer driver may not be installed properly.  
Reinstall the printer driver.  
Computer may not have enough memory.  
Install more RAM in your computer.  
Printing is too slow  
Print quality is poor  
The print job is large or complex.  
The machine takes a lot of times when printing a large print jobs. Please wait  
until the machine finishes the job.  
See “Print quality problems,” on page 14-29.  
Some software applications will overwrite the option set on the printer property page.  
Choose your printing options from the application.  
The printing option does not  
effect for the printouts.  
* In order to use your machine as a local or network printer you should have the  
applicable print driver installed from CD supplied with your machine.  
14-28 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Local Scanner errors  
*
Symptom  
Suggested solutions  
The TWAIN driver may not be installed properly.  
Reinstall the printer driver.  
Cannot scan a document  
The TWAIN driver may not be installed properly.  
Reinstall the printer driver.  
“Muratec Color TWAIN Scanner”  
does not appear in the list of the  
available scanner device on your  
application software.  
1
2
The document glass or ADF glass may be dirty.  
Clean the glass (see page 14-2.)  
Scanned image looks dirty  
3
Change the scanning contrast by pressing [Contrast].  
Change the scanning resolution by pressing [Resolution].  
Change the document type by pressing [Doc.Type].  
4
* In order to use your machine as a local scanner you should have the driver  
installed from CD supplied with your machine.  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Print quality problems  
The document is loaded incorrectly.  
Set the document facing up on the ADF or facing down on the document  
glass.*  
Pages are blank  
The toner cartridge may be defective.  
Remove the toner cartridge and check it for damage.  
If the problem persists, replace the toner cartridge.  
The drum charge wire may be dirty.  
Pages are black  
Open the front cover. To clean the drum charge wire, pull the blue rod toward  
you, making sure it fully extends. Then return the rod to its original position.  
(See page 14-4.)  
The toner cartridge may be defective.  
Remove the toner cartridge and check it for damage.  
If the problem persists, contact Muratec dealer.  
Contrast selected was too light.  
Select a darker contrast setting.  
Printouts are too light  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
The toner cartridge may be out of toner, or the toner may be very low.  
Replace the toner cartridge.  
The paper is damp.  
Replace the paper.  
Contrast selected was too dark.  
Select a lighter contrast setting.  
Printouts are too dark  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
The document glass* or ADF glass is dirty.  
Wipe the glass with a dry soft cloth.  
Printouts have a blurred  
background  
The drum charge wire may be dirty.  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Open the front cover. To clean the drum charge wire, pull the blue rod toward  
you, making sure it fully extends. Then return the rod to its original position.  
(See page 14-4.)  
The toner cartridge may be defective.  
Remove the toner cartridge and check it for damage.  
If the problem persists, replace the toner cartridge.  
The drum cartridge may be defective.  
Remove the drum cartridge and check it for damage.  
If the problem persists, replace the drum cartridge.  
Printouts are of uneven  
density  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
The paper you are using may have absorbed moisture, perhaps due either to  
high humidity or water having been spilled on the paper supply. Toner will  
not adhere well to wet paper.  
Printouts have irregularities  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ACDE  
ABCDE  
Replace the paper with dry paper.  
14-30 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The ADF glass or rollers of the ADF may be dirty.  
Clean the ADF glass and/or the rollers of the ADF. (See pages 14-2 to 14-4.)  
Printouts have white and/or  
black lines  
The drum charge wire may be dirty.  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Open the front cover. To clean the drum charge wire, pull the blue rod toward  
you, making sure it fully extends. Then return the rod to its original position.  
(See page 14-4.)  
The toner cartridge or drum cartridge may be defective.  
Remove the cartridges and check them for damage.  
1
If the problem persists, replace either or both of the cartridges as indicated.  
The document glass* is dirty.  
Wipe the document glass* with a dry soft cloth.  
Printouts have toner smudges  
2
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
The document pad* is dirty  
Clean the document pad* with a soft cloth dampened and a mild detergent.  
3
The drum charge wire may be dirty.  
Open the front cover. To clean the drum charge wire, pull the blue rod toward  
you, making sure it fully extends. Then return the rod to its original position.  
(See page 14-4.)  
4
5
The toner cartridge or drum cartridge may be defective.  
Remove the cartridges and check them for damage. If the problem persists,  
replace either or both of the cartridges as indicated.  
6
If you find smudges on the back of the printouts, the transport roller may be  
dirty.  
Your machine normally cleans the transport roller automatically. If other  
solutions fail, please contact your Muratec dealer.  
7
The document is not positioned correctly.  
Correctly adjust the document guides for the size of the document.  
The image is not aligned prop-  
erly on the paper.  
8
The ADF glass is dirty (while using the ADF).  
Wipe the ADF glass with a dry soft cloth. (See page 14-2.)  
9
The document guides are not slid up against the edges of the document.  
Slide the document guides against the edges of the document.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Curled paper was loaded into the paper cassette.  
Flatten the paper before loading it.  
* The document glass and the document pad is available for MFX-2030/MFX-1430 only.  
MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING 14-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you cannot solve the problem  
If you have a problem with your machine that you cannot solve with the information provided in  
this chapter, contact your local Muratec dealer or call the Muratec Customer Support Center at  
(800) 347-3296 (from U. S. only).  
CAUTION: If you detect odd sounds, smoke or odor emitting from your machine, unplug it  
immediately and contact your local Muratec dealer. Do not attempt to disas-  
semble or repair the machine yourself.  
IMPORTANT:Attempting to repair the machine yourself may void the limited warranty.  
When you contact the Muratec Customer Sup-  
port Center, make sure you have the following  
information ready;  
• Product name: F-560 or F-520 or MFX-2030  
or MFX-1430  
• Serial number (located on the label located  
at the back of the machine)  
• Details of the problem  
• Steps taken to try to resolve the problem  
and the results  
Bar code label  
D A 7 0 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 8 C A  
*
Close up, the bar code label looks  
something like this, but with a  
different set of numbers.  
14-32 MAINTENANCE & TROUBLESHOOTING  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter  
AI  
Appendix & Index  
Specifications........................................................................................AI-2  
General..........................................................................................AI-2  
Fax .................................................................................................AI-3  
Copy...............................................................................................AI-3  
Printer ...........................................................................................AI-3  
Scanner..........................................................................................AI-4  
Consumable items.........................................................................AI-4  
Index.....................................................................................................AI-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications  
General  
Multitasking  
Scanning method  
Printing method  
Quad Access  
Flatbed CCD  
LED  
Acceptable document size (See page 2-10)  
Document weight  
Printing paper size  
Power requirement  
Power consumption  
(See page 2-10)  
(See page 2-12)  
120 VAC 50/60 Hz.  
Energy save mode: Approx. 15 W  
Standby: Approx. 50 Wh (MFX-1430/F-520)  
Approx. 63 Wh (MFX-2030/F-560)  
Maximum: Approx. 1040 W  
Environmental temperature 10 to 32 oC  
Relative humidity 20 to 80 %RH  
Display (Liquid Crystal Display) Touch panel display  
Image memory capacity 7.8 MB (650 pages* approx.)  
plus optional 32 MB (additional 2,720 pages* approx.)  
*Using the ITU-T test document 1 with normal resolution.  
Image memory backup time 7.8 MB: 72 hours*  
39.8 MB: 24 hours*  
*Must be charged for at least 24 hours to reach full charge  
Weight  
MFX-2030: Approx. 48.7 lb. (22.1 kg)  
MFX-1430: Approx. 48.1 lb. (21.8 kg)  
F-560: Approx. 44.8 lb. (20.3 kg)  
F-520: Approx. 44.1 lb. (20.0 kg)  
(Without consumables and tray)  
ADF capacity  
Paper cassette capacity  
Up to 80 sheets (Letter, 75 g/m2 or 20 lb. paper)  
Paper cassette; 500 sheets (80 g/m2 or 20 lb. paper)  
Bypass tray; 50 sheets (80 g/m2 or 20 lb. paper)  
250 sheets (80 g/m2 or 20 lb. paper)  
Exit paper tray capacity  
Dimensions (W×D×H)  
20.5 × 19.3 × 17.6 in. (520 × 490 × 446 mm)  
AI-2 APPENDIX & INDEX  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax  
Compatibility  
Applicable line  
Coding method  
Modem speed  
ITU-T Group 3 and Super Group 3  
Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) or equivalent  
ITU-T-standard MMR, MR, MH and JBIG  
33,600, 31,200, 28,800, 26,400, 24,000, 21,600, 19,200,  
16,800, 14,400, 12,000, 9,600, 7,200, 4,800, 2,400 bps  
Automatic fallback  
1
Address book  
Call group  
Broadcasting  
Transmission speed  
Up to 300 destinations can be stored  
32 groups  
330 destinations  
2
3
Approx. 3 seconds/page.*  
* Based on memory-to-memory transmission of ITU-T test document 1  
to a Muratec fax machine. Your transmission times will vary, but your  
machine always will provide the fastest transmission speeds possible  
under ITU-T guidelines and phone-line conditions.  
4
Scanning width  
Grayscale  
8.2 in. (208 mm)  
256-levels  
5
Scanning resolution  
Normal (8 dots/mm × 3.85 lines/mm)  
Fine (8 dots/mm × 7.7 lines/mm)  
Super-fine (16 dots/mm × 15.4 lines/mm) *  
* In the case that the remote fax has the ability of “16 dots/mm × 15.4  
lines/mm”. Otherwise, the superfine resolution is “8 dots/mm × 15.4 lines/  
mm”.  
6
7
8
Grayscale (8 dots/mm × 7.7 lines/mm)  
9
Copy  
Scanning resolution  
Scanning width  
Print speed  
600 dpi × 300 lpi or 600 dpi. × 600 lpi.  
8.5 in. (216 mm)  
MFX-2030/F-560: 20 ppm*  
MFX-1430/F-520: 14 ppm*  
* Using Letter-sized paper in 1st paper cassette.  
Automatic document feeder: 25 to 100 %  
Document glass*: 25 to 400 %  
Automatic document feeder: 100 %, 78 %, 64 %, 50 %  
Document glass*: 154 %,129 %,121 %,100 %,78 %,64 %,50 %  
* The document glass is available for MFX-2030 and MFX-1430.  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
Zoom ratio  
Preset ratio  
Printer  
Print resolution  
Print speed  
600 dpi  
MFX-2030/F-560: 20 ppm*  
MFGX-1430/F-520: 14 ppm*  
* Using Letter-sized paper in 1st paper cassette.  
Color /Mono  
Monochrome  
Operating system  
Windows 98, Me, NT 4.0, 2000, XP (English version)  
Windows server 2003 (English version)  
Printer language  
Interface  
GDI (standard), PCL (option)  
USB port  
Ethernet port  
APPENDIX & INDEX AI-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scanner  
Color/Mono  
Color or Monochrome  
Scanning resolution  
Scanning width  
Color: 600 dpi, 300 dpi, 200 dpi, 100 dpi  
Monochorme: 600 dpi, 300 dpi, 200 dpi  
8.2 in. (208 mm)  
Consumable items  
MFX-2030/MFX-1430  
Drum cartridge life  
Toner cartridge life  
Approx. 30,000 pages*  
Approx. 16,000 pages*  
Starter toner cartridge life Approx. 3,000 pages*  
*Based on 6% document coverage and letter-sized two-page interval printing.  
F-560/F-520  
Drum cartridge life  
Toner cartridge life  
Approx. 20,000 pages*  
Approx. 15,000 pages*  
Starter toner cartridge life Approx. 4,000 pages*  
*Based on 4% document coverage and letter-sized two-page interval printing.  
NOTE: Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
AI-4 APPENDIX & INDEX  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Document size ............................. 7-27  
Document type ...................... 5-4, 7-8  
Drum cartridge  
replacing ................................. 14-7  
Duplex copy ................................. 7-16  
Duplex scanning .......................... 5-61  
Index  
A
Activity journal ........................... 13-5  
Address book ................................. 2-2  
deleting ......................... 2-10, 2-11  
how to dial .............................. 2-12  
registering/editing 2-4, 2-7, 2-8, 2-9  
Attachment .................................. 5-64  
Auto Reset Time ........................ 12-11  
1
E
e-mail subject ...................... 4-7, 5-24  
ECM mode ................................... 12-6  
Energy save mode ........... 1-23, 12-12  
Erased document notification ... 13-10  
Errors  
copying .................................. 14-28  
faxing .................................... 14-26  
local scanner ......................... 14-29  
machine ................................ 14-26  
PC printing ........................... 14-28  
scanning ............................... 14-27  
Error codes ................................ 14-24  
Error messages .......................... 14-16  
2
3
B
4
Batch scanning .................. 4-11, 5-59  
Batch transmission ..................... 3-35  
Block junk fax .............................. 3-46  
Broadcasting ...................... 3-24, 5-63  
5
6
C
Call group .................................... 2-14  
deleting ................................... 2-15  
how to dial .............................. 2-16  
registering/editing .................. 2-14  
Card Copy .................................... 7-25  
Character  
entering .................................. 1-10  
Check mail ................................... 4-12  
Check message .......................... 14-23  
Cleaning  
ADF rollers ............................. 14-3  
drum charge wire ................... 14-3  
print head ............................... 14-3  
scanning area ......................... 14-2  
Color ............................................. 5-56  
Combine copy .............................. 7-14  
Control panel ................................. 1-3  
Copy print queue ............... 3-18, 7-28  
Copy protection ......................... 11-22  
Copy reservation ........................... 7-7  
Copy settings ............................... 12-3  
Cover page ................................... 3-32  
7
F
8
F-code box feature ..................... 10-21  
Fax & Copy .................................. 3-28  
Fax forwarding ............................ 3-51  
Fax reception  
print settings .......................... 3-20  
Fax reception mode ..................... 3-15  
ans/fax ready mode ................ 3-16  
fax/tel ready mode .................. 3-16  
fax ready mode ....................... 3-16  
tel/fax ready mode .................. 3-16  
tel ready mode ........................ 3-15  
Fax settings ................................. 12-4  
File format ......................... 4-13, 5-60  
File name ....................................... 5-6  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
H
Half-page reception ..................... 12-6  
I
D
Initial settings ............................. 1-16  
broadcasting ........................... 1-18  
date & time ............................. 1-17  
daylight savings ..................... 1-18  
default TTI ............................. 1-21  
dial tone detection .................. 1-20  
fax reception mode ................. 1-19  
language ................................. 1-17  
Delayed transmission ................. 3-34  
Department management ......... 11-13  
Dial prefix .................................... 3-44  
Document handling ..................... 1-24  
acceptable documents ............ 1-24  
Document jams ............................ 14-9  
APPENDIX & INDEX AI-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
phone dialing type .................. 1-19  
time zone ................................ 1-22  
TTI (your name) ..................... 1-20  
your fax number ..................... 1-21  
how to dial .............................. 2-19  
how to receive ......................... 2-20  
optional handset volume ....... 2-20  
speaker volume ...................... 2-21  
PIN masking ............................... 11-7  
Polling reception .......................... 3-50  
Polling transmission ................... 3-42  
Print quality problems .............. 14-30  
Program one-touch .................... 10-14  
J
Journal report  
Sorting the job (Line up) ...... 12-12  
Journal reports ............................ 13-2  
Q
L
Quick memory transmission 3-3, 12-6  
QWERTY keypad ........................ 1-10  
Lists ............................................. 13-2  
Loading documents ..................... 1-25  
Loading paper  
into bypass tray ...................... 1-29  
into paper cassettes ............... 1-27  
Location display .......................... 3-26  
R
Re-mail ................................ 4-3, 5-22  
Real-time transmission ................. 3-4  
sending ..................................... 3-8  
Receive time stamp ..................... 12-6  
Redialing ...................................... 3-13  
automatic ................................ 3-13  
manual .................................... 3-13  
Review commands ......................... 6-2  
results of fax transaction ......... 6-8  
M
Macro keys ................................... 10-7  
Mail history ......................... 4-4, 5-21  
Mail settings ................................ 12-9  
Maintenance ................................ 14-2  
Management settings ............... 12-11  
Manual transmission .................... 3-4  
sending ..................................... 3-9  
Memory overflow message .... 3-4, 7-2  
Memory transmission ................... 3-3  
sending ............................. 3-5, 3-6  
S
Scanner settings .......................... 12-7  
Scanning contrast .......... 3-3, 5-3, 7-9  
Scanning resolution .............. 3-2, 5-2  
Scan size .............................. 3-41, 5-5  
Scan to e-mail ................................ 5-9  
search ...................................... 5-15  
selecting destination .............. 5-11  
sending ..................................... 5-9  
Scan to folder ............................... 5-28  
folder shortcut ........................ 5-33  
registering/editingfoldershortcut . 5-35  
Scan to FTP 5-42  
N
Next document setting .................. 7-3  
O
Out-of-paper reception ................ 3-18  
Overseas transmission ................ 3-43  
registering/editingFTPshortcut . 5-49  
registering FTP shortcut ....... 5-45  
Security features ......................... 11-2  
Security reception ....................... 11-3  
Separate reception page ........... 12-14  
Separator page ............................ 3-57  
Soft keys ...................................... 10-2  
Sorting ......................................... 7-13  
Sound settings ........................... 12-12  
Stored document list ................... 13-9  
P
Page counters ............................ 10-39  
Paper handling ............................ 1-26  
acceptable paper sizes ........... 1-26  
paper type setting .................. 1-30  
Paper jams ................................. 14-13  
Paper settings ............................ 12-14  
Paper size .................................... 7-11  
Passcode protection ..................... 11-2  
Phone call .................................... 2-19  
call fails .................................. 2-20  
AI-6 APPENDIX & INDEX  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
T
Toner cartridge  
replacing ................................. 14-5  
Transmission confirmation report . 13-8  
Troubleshooting .......................... 14-9  
TTI ............................................... 3-30  
1
Z
2
Zoom ................................... 5-57, 7-12  
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
AI  
APPENDIX & INDEX AI-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AI-8 APPENDIX & INDEX  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Accusplit Heart Rate Monitor S602XE User Manual
AEG Power Supply 400 KVA User Manual
Aiphone Intercom System JF 1FD User Manual
Aiphone Musical Table AI SSV User Manual
Allied Telesis Switch 261 User Manual
Allied Telesis Switch AR700 Series User Manual
Americana Appliances Freezer A3315ABR User Manual
Atlantis Land Switch A07 ES4704BD User Manual
Axis Communications Printer AXIS 5400+ User Manual
BC Speakers Speaker DE60TN User Manual